Service Manual - Sp4510sf
Service Manual - Sp4510sf
Service Manual - Sp4510sf
M160/M161
It is the reader's responsibility when discussing the information contained
within this document to maintain a level of confidentiality that is in the best
interest of Ricoh Americas Corporation and its member companies.
DOCUMENTATION HISTORY
REV. NO. DATE COMMENTS
* 01/2015 Original Printing
M160/M161
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM i M160/M161
2.5 SD CARD APPLI MOVE .............................................................................................. 2-23
2.5.1 OVERVIEW ....................................................................................................... 2-23
2.5.2 NOTES ON USING THE SD MERGE FUNCTION ........................................... 2-23
2.5.3 SD CARD APPLICATIONS ............................................................................... 2-24
2.5.4 MOVE EXEC ..................................................................................................... 2-24
2.5.5 UNDO EXEC ..................................................................................................... 2-26
2.6 IPDS UNIT TYPE M6 ................................................................................................... 2-28
2.6.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..................................................................................... 2-28
2.6.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 2-28
2.7 SD CARD FOR NETWARE PRINTING TYPE M6 ...................................................... 2-30
2.7.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..................................................................................... 2-30
2.7.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 2-30
2.8 BROWSER UNIT TYPE M6 ......................................................................................... 2-32
2.8.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..................................................................................... 2-32
2.8.2 OUTLINE OF THE BROWSER UNIT ............................................................... 2-32
2.8.3 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 2-33
2.8.4 RICOH JAVASCRIPT ........................................................................................ 2-36
2.8.5 EXJS FIRMWARE UPDATE.............................................................................. 2-36
Preparation ............................................................................................................ 2-37
Main procedure...................................................................................................... 2-37
2.8.6 UPDATING THE EXTENDED JAVASCRIPT .................................................... 2-38
2.8.7 UN-INSTALLING EXJS FIRMWARE................................................................. 2-39
2.9 XPS DIRECT PRINT OPTION TYPE M6 .................................................................... 2-40
2.9.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..................................................................................... 2-40
2.9.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 2-40
2.10 VM CARD TYPE W ............................................................................................... 2-42
2.10.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..................................................................................... 2-42
2.10.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 2-42
2.11 OCR UNIT TYPE M2 ................................................................................................... 2-44
2.11.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..................................................................................... 2-44
2.11.2 DETAILS ABOUT SEARCHABLE PDF ............................................................. 2-44
2.11.3 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 2-45
Restoration Procedure .......................................................................................... 2-46
2.12 MEMORY UNIT TYPE M1 1.5GB ......................................................................... 2-48
2.12.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..................................................................................... 2-48
2.12.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 2-48
2.13 HARD DISK DRIVE OPTION TYPE M6 ............................................................... 2-51
2.13.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..................................................................................... 2-51
2.13.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 2-51
M160/M161 ii SM
2.14 FILE FORMAT CONVERTER TYPE E ................................................................. 2-55
2.14.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..................................................................................... 2-55
2.14.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 2-55
2.15 IEEE 1284 INTERFACE BOARD TYPE A ............................................................ 2-57
2.15.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..................................................................................... 2-57
2.15.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 2-57
2.16 IEEE802.11 INTERFACE UNIT TYPE O .............................................................. 2-59
2.16.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..................................................................................... 2-59
2.16.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 2-59
2.16.3 UP MODE SETTINGS FOR WIRELESS LAN .................................................. 2-60
2.16.4 SP MODE AND UP MODE SETTINGS FOR IEEE 802.11 A/B/G/N, WIRELESS
LAN 2-62
2.17 BLUETOOTH INTERFACE UNIT TYPE D ............................................................ 2-63
2.17.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..................................................................................... 2-63
2.17.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 2-64
2.18 COPY DATA SECURITY UNIT TYPE G ............................................................... 2-65
2.18.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..................................................................................... 2-65
2.18.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 2-66
2.18.3 USER TOOL SETTING ..................................................................................... 2-68
2.19 DATA OVERWRITE SECURITY UNIT TYPE I...................................................... 2-69
2.19.1 OVERVIEW ....................................................................................................... 2-69
2.19.2 COMPONENT LIST........................................................................................... 2-69
2.19.3 BEFORE YOU BEGIN THE PROCEDURE ...................................................... 2-69
Seal Check and Removal ...................................................................................... 2-70
2.19.4 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................................... 2-71
2.20 SECURITY SETTINGS ......................................................................................... 2-72
2.20.1 SECURITY FUNCTION INSTALLATION .......................................................... 2-72
2.20.2 DATA OVERWRITE SECURITY ....................................................................... 2-73
Before You Begin the Procedure ........................................................................... 2-73
Installation Procedure ............................................................................................ 2-73
Using Auto Erase Memory..................................................................................... 2-74
2.20.3 HDD ENCRYPTION .......................................................................................... 2-75
Before You Begin the Procedure: .......................................................................... 2-75
Installation Procedure ............................................................................................ 2-75
Enable Encryption Setting ..................................................................................... 2-76
Backing Up the Encryption Key............................................................................. 2-77
Encryption Key Restoration ................................................................................... 2-78
2.21 SETTINGS FOR @REMOTE SERVICE ............................................................... 2-80
2.21.1 CHECK POINTS BEFORE MAKING @REMOTE SETTINGS......................... 2-80
SM iii M160/M161
2.21.2 EXECUTE THE @REMOTE SETTINGS .......................................................... 2-81
M160/M161 iv SM
4.8.9 RELAY CLUTCH ............................................................................................... 4-27
4.8.10 BY-PASS BOTTOM PLATE CLUTCH ............................................................... 4-28
4.8.11 DUPLEX CLUTCH ............................................................................................ 4-28
4.8.12 JUNCTION GATE SOLENOID .......................................................................... 4-29
4.9 FUSING ........................................................................................................................ 4-30
4.9.1 FUSING UNIT.................................................................................................... 4-30
4.9.2 UPPER FUSING UNIT / LOWER FUSING UNIT ............................................. 4-31
4.9.3 FUSING PRESSURE ROLLER ........................................................................ 4-32
4.9.4 FUSING LAMP / HOT ROLLER ........................................................................ 4-33
4.9.5 THERMOSTAT .................................................................................................. 4-35
4.9.6 THERMISTOR ................................................................................................... 4-36
4.9.7 HOT ROLLER STRIPPER ................................................................................ 4-38
4.10 PAPER FEED ........................................................................................................ 4-39
4.10.1 PAPER FEED TRAY.......................................................................................... 4-39
4.10.2 PAPER FEED ROLLER .................................................................................... 4-39
4.10.3 FRICTION PAD ................................................................................................. 4-40
4.10.4 PAPER END SENSOR...................................................................................... 4-40
4.10.5 BY-PASS FEED UNIT ....................................................................................... 4-41
4.10.6 BY-PASS FEED ROLLER ................................................................................. 4-42
4.10.7 BY-PASS FRICTION PAD ................................................................................. 4-43
4.10.8 BY-PASS PAPER END SENSOR ..................................................................... 4-44
4.10.9 BY-PASS BOTTOM PLATE HP SENSOR ........................................................ 4-45
4.10.10 PAPER SIZE DETECTION SWITCH.......................................................... 4-45
4.11 PAPER TRANSPORT .................................................................................................. 4-47
4.11.1 PAPER EXIT SENSOR ..................................................................................... 4-47
4.11.2 PAPER OVERFLOW SENSOR......................................................................... 4-47
4.11.3 DUPLEX EXIT SENSOR ................................................................................... 4-47
4.11.4 DUPLEX ENTRANCE SENSOR ....................................................................... 4-48
4.11.5 REGISTRATION ROLLER (DRIVEN) ............................................................... 4-49
4.11.6 REGISTRATION ROLLER (DRIVE).................................................................. 4-51
4.11.7 REGISTRATION SENSOR ............................................................................... 4-51
4.12 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ............................................................................. 4-53
4.12.1 FCU BOARD ..................................................................................................... 4-53
4.12.2 SPEAKER .......................................................................................................... 4-55
4.12.3 PSU ................................................................................................................... 4-56
4.12.4 CONTROLLER BOARD .................................................................................... 4-58
Before replacing the controller board in the model without HDD.......................... 4-58
Replacement Procedure........................................................................................ 4-58
After installing the controller board ........................................................................ 4-59
SM v M160/M161
4.12.5 NVRAM ON THE CONTROLLER BOARD ....................................................... 4-60
4.12.6 BICU .................................................................................................................. 4-61
4.12.7 EEPROM ON THE BICU................................................................................... 4-62
4.12.8 HDD ................................................................................................................... 4-63
Before HDD Replacement ..................................................................................... 4-63
Replacement Procedure........................................................................................ 4-63
After HDD Replacement ........................................................................................ 4-63
Reinstallation ......................................................................................................... 4-64
4.12.9 TONER END SENSOR ..................................................................................... 4-64
4.12.10 HVPS .......................................................................................................... 4-65
4.12.11 HVPS WITH BRACKET .............................................................................. 4-66
4.12.12 FUSING FAN............................................................................................... 4-67
4.12.13 PCDU COOLING FAN ................................................................................ 4-68
4.12.14 PSU COOLING FAN ................................................................................... 4-68
4.12.15 DC SWITCH................................................................................................ 4-70
4.12.16 FRONT DOOR INTERLOCK SWITCH....................................................... 4-70
4.12.17 REAR DOOR INTERLOCK SWITCH ......................................................... 4-71
4.12.18 DIMM........................................................................................................... 4-71
4.12.19 TEMP HUMID SENSOR ............................................................................. 4-72
4.12.20 REAR COVER SWITCH ............................................................................. 4-72
4.13 ARDF ..................................................................................................................... 4-73
4.13.1 ARDF UNIT ....................................................................................................... 4-73
4.13.2 ARDF FRONT COVER ..................................................................................... 4-75
4.13.3 ARDF REAR COVER ........................................................................................ 4-76
4.13.4 ARDF TOP COVER ........................................................................................... 4-77
4.13.5 ARDF ORIGINAL TRAY .................................................................................... 4-78
4.13.6 ORIGINAL FEED UNIT ..................................................................................... 4-78
4.13.7 ARDF FRICTION PAD ...................................................................................... 4-79
4.13.8 ARDF DRIVE MOTOR ...................................................................................... 4-79
4.13.9 ARDF TOP COVER SENSOR .......................................................................... 4-82
4.13.10 ARDF ORIGINAL SET SENSOR ................................................................ 4-82
4.13.11 ARDF REGISTRATION SENSOR .............................................................. 4-83
4.13.12 DFRB .......................................................................................................... 4-84
4.13.13 PICK-UP SOLENOID .................................................................................. 4-85
4.13.14 JUNCTION GATE SOLENOID ................................................................... 4-85
4.14 SCANNER ............................................................................................................. 4-87
4.14.1 SCANNER UNIT (WITH ARDF) ........................................................................ 4-87
4.14.2 SCANNER UPPER COVER.............................................................................. 4-90
4.14.3 ARDF OPEN/CLOSED SENSOR ..................................................................... 4-90
M160/M161 vi SM
4.14.4 CARRIAGE ........................................................................................................ 4-91
4.14.5 CARRIAGE UNIT HP SENSOR ........................................................................ 4-92
4.14.6 SCANNER MOTOR........................................................................................... 4-93
6. TROUBLESHOOTING................................................................... 6-1
6.1 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE........................................................................................... 6-1
6.1.1 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE AT POWER ON...................................................... 6-1
SM vii M160/M161
6.2 SERVICE CALL ............................................................................................................. 6-2
6.2.1 SUMMARY .......................................................................................................... 6-2
When a Level “D” SC code occurs .......................................................................... 6-2
6.2.2 SC100 (SCANNING) ........................................................................................... 6-3
6.2.3 SC200 (LED OPTICS) ......................................................................................... 6-7
6.2.4 SC300 (IMAGE PROCESSING – 1) ................................................................... 6-9
6.2.5 SC400 (IMAGE PROCESSING – 2) ................................................................. 6-11
6.2.6 SC500 (PAPER FEED AND FUSING) .............................................................. 6-12
6.2.7 SC600 (DEVICE COMMUNICATION) .............................................................. 6-20
6.2.8 SC700 (PERIPHERALS) ................................................................................... 6-35
6.2.9 SC800 (CONTROLLER) ................................................................................... 6-35
6.2.10 SC900 (OTHERS) ........................................................................................... 6-102
6.3 JAM DETECTION ...................................................................................................... 6-108
6.3.1 JAM DISPLAYS ............................................................................................... 6-108
6.3.2 JAM HISTORY................................................................................................. 6-108
6.3.3 SENSOR POSITION LAYOUT ........................................................................ 6-109
6.3.4 SENSOR POSITION ....................................................................................... 6-109
ARDF ................................................................................................................... 6-110
Main Machine ...................................................................................................... 6-110
Optional Bank ...................................................................................................... 6-111
6.4 TROUBLESHOOTING ............................................................................................... 6-112
6.4.1 TEST PATTERN PRINTING ............................................................................ 6-112
6.4.2 IMAGE POSITION ADJUSTMENT ................................................................. 6-113
6.4.3 REGISTRATION ADJUSTMENT .................................................................... 6-114
Print Area ............................................................................................................. 6-114
Adjustment Reference Values ............................................................................. 6-114
Adjustment Procedure ......................................................................................... 6-114
6.4.4 SCANNER, ARDF IMAGE ADJUSTMENT ..................................................... 6-115
Scanner Image Adjustment ................................................................................. 6-115
ARDF Image Adjustment ..................................................................................... 6-116
6.4.5 PROBLEM AT REGULAR INTERVALS .......................................................... 6-117
When Vertical Banding is Generated .................................................................. 6-118
When Black Spots are Generated on Print Image .............................................. 6-119
6.4.6 PAPER FEED (SKEW) .................................................................................... 6-120
6.4.7 STACK ERROR (SPILLING OF THE PAPER STACKED IN THE OUTPUT TRAY)
6-120
6.4.8 RECYCLED OR THIN PAPER IS SEVERELY CURLED AFTER PRINTING 6-121
M160/M161 viii SM
7.1.1 ENERGY SAVER MODES .................................................................................. 7-1
Sleep Mode Setting ................................................................................................. 7-1
Weekly Timer ........................................................................................................... 7-2
Fusing Off Mode ...................................................................................................... 7-3
Return to Stand-by Mode ........................................................................................ 7-3
Recommendation .................................................................................................... 7-4
7.1.2 ENERGY SAVE EFFECTIVENESS .................................................................... 7-4
7.2 PAPER SAVE ................................................................................................................. 7-6
7.2.1 EFFECTIVENESS OF DUPLEX/COMBINE FUNCTION ................................... 7-6
1. Duplex: ................................................................................................................ 7-6
2. Combine mode: ................................................................................................... 7-6
3. Duplex + Combine: .............................................................................................. 7-7
Recommendation .................................................................................................... 7-7
SM ix M160/M161
READ THIS FIRST
To prevent a fire or explosion, keep the machine away from flammable liquids, gases,
and aerosols.
Do not use a vacuum cleaner to remove spilled toner (including used toner). Vacuumed
toner may cause a fire or explosion due to sparks or electrical contact inside the cleaner.
However, it is possible to use a cleaner designed to be dust explosion-proof. If toner is
spilled over the floor, sweep up spilled toner slowly and clean up any remaining toner with
a wet cloth.
See or Refer to
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
E-ring
Trademarks
NetWare is registered trademark of Novell, Inc. in the USA.
PostScript® is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL® is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of
their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
PRODUCT INFORMATION
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
Product Overview
1. PRODUCT INFORMATION
Information
Product
1.1 PRODUCT OVERVIEW
SM 1-1 M160/M161
Product Overview
M160/M161 1-2 SM
Product Overview
Information
Product
1. Duplex exit motor
2. Fusing drive gear
3. Drum gear
4. Registration clutch
5. Toner supply clutch
6. By-pass feed clutch
7. By-pass bottom plate clutch
8. Relay clutch
9. Paper feed clutch
10. Main motor
11. Duplex clutch
SM 1-3 M160/M161
Machine Codes and Peripheral Configuration
CONFIGURATION
M160-17 (NA)
M160
M160-27 (EU/AP) NEW
(User Maintenance Model)
M160-21 (CHN)
M161-17 (NA)
M161
M161-27 (EU) NEW
(Service Maintenance Model)
M161-29 (AP)
M160/M161 1-4 SM
Machine Codes and Peripheral Configuration
Information
Product
Item Machine Code Remarks
SM 1-5 M160/M161
Machine Codes and Peripheral Configuration
M160/M161 1-6 SM
Consumables for M161 (Service Maintenance Model)
Information
Product
Item Machine Code Remarks Yield
(ISO): The number of printable pages is based on pages that are compliant with ISO/IEC
19752 with the image density set as the factory default. ISO/IEC 19752 is an international
standard for measurement of printable pages, set by the International Organization for
Standardization.
(6%, 3P/J): A4/Letter 6% test chart, 3 pages/job.
(3P/J): A4/Letter, 3 pages/job.
SM 1-7 M160/M161
INSTALLATION
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
Installation Requirements
2. INSTALLATION
2.1.1 ENVIRONMENT
Installation
1. Temperature Range: 10°C to 32°C (50°F to 89.6°F)
2. Humidity Range: 15% to 80% RH
3. Ambient Illumination: Less than 1,500 lux (do not expose to direct sunlight)
4. Ventilation: 3 times/hr/person
5. Do not install the machine at locations over 2,000 m (6,562 ft.) above sea level.
SM 2-1 M160/M161
Installation Requirements
M160/M161 2-2 SM
Installation Requirements
Installation
[A] 419 mm (16.5 inches)
SM 2-3 M160/M161
Installation Requirements
M160/M161 2-4 SM
Main Machine Installation
The user maintenance model (M160) is for installation by users. However, the customer
engineer must do the installation if the sales representative requests it.
Installation
The service maintenance model (M161) is for installation by the customer engineer.
Overview
The following Program/Change Administrator screen is displayed at the first power-up.
When the customers set the administrator/supervisor login password, the display disappears
and the home display will appear. The customers, however, can erase this screen with the
following procedure if they think there is no need to set the password.
1. On the Program/Change Administrator screen, press [Change] next to Supervisor and
then touch [OK] without inputting any password.
2. Touch [OK] again when the Confirm password display shows up.
3. For Administrator 1, do the same procedure as steps 1 and 2.
4. Press the [OK] button, then the home display appears.
SP5-755-002 allows you to skip this screen temporarily and continue the installation
procedure without setting an administrator password. However, the Program/Change
Administrator screen appears every time you turn the power OFF/ON, if the password is not
set.
SM 2-5 M160/M161
Main Machine Installation
For more details about this security issue, see “Notes on Using Multi-Function Printers
Safely” supplied with the MFP.
When Supervisor / Administrator 1-4 passwords are configured via network, the “Change
Supervisor login password” window will not display.
The passwords for Supervisor or Administrator 1 to 4 can be set via “System Settings”.
But the Program/Change Administrator screen appears every time the power switch is
turned ON if the passwords are input this way. So we recommend the customers to set
the passwords via network or the Program/Change Administrator screen.
1. Install the MFP.
2. Turn the main power switch ON.
3. Change the Supervisor login password.
5. Press [OK].
M160/M161 2-6 SM
Main Machine Installation
Installation
6. Confirm the Password.
7. Press [OK].
SM 2-7 M160/M161
Main Machine Installation
M160/M161 2-8 SM
Main Machine Installation
Installation
12. Press [OK].
Q’ty
Description
-17 -21 -27
Power Cord 1 1 1
Ferrite Core - 1 -
Cleaner:Lens:LED Head 1 1 1
Sheet - Notes_FCC 1 - -
SM 2-9 M160/M161
Main Machine Installation
Q’ty
Description
-17 -21 -27
Sheet – SECU 1 1 1
CD-ROM – Driver 1 - 1
CD-ROM – OI 1 - 1
CD-ROM - Driver/OI - 1 -
Seal – Caution 1 1 1
Decal – Function 1 1 1
Warranty (English) 1 - -
Warranty (Chinese) - 1 -
M160/M161 2-10 SM
Main Machine Installation
Q’ty
Description
-17 -21 -27
Starter Toner
User maintenance model (M160) : 6,000 1 1 1
Installation
pages
Q’ty
Description
-17 -27 -29
Power Cord 1 1 1
Cleaner:Lens:LED Head 1 1 1
Sheet - Notes_FCC 1 - -
Sheet - Notes_SECU 1 1 1
Sheet - Notes_Envelope 1 1 1
CD-ROM – Driver 1 1 1
CD-ROM - OI 1 1 1
Seal – Caution 1 1 1
Decal – Function 1 1 1
SM 2-11 M160/M161
Main Machine Installation
Q’ty
Description
-17 -27 -29
PLATE:LOGOTYPE:GES:IG - - 1
PLATE:LOGOTYPE:LAN:IG - - 1
PLATE:LOGO:RIC 1 1 1
Starter Toner
Service maintenance model (M161) : 10,400 1 1 1
pages
When lifting the machine, use the inset grips on both sides. The machine could break or
cause an injury if dropped.
1. Remove the machine from the box, and check the items in the package.
2. Remove the adhesive tape attached on the machine's exterior.
Pull out the paper tray, and then remove the adhesive tape [A] on its side.
M160/M161 2-12 SM
Main Machine Installation
Installation
3. Open the rear cover, and then remove the adhesive tape from the machine and the
envelope lever.
4. Pull up the envelope lever, and then close the rear cover.
SM 2-13 M160/M161
Main Machine Installation
6. Pull up the open lever of the ARDF cover, and then open the ARDF cover.
7. Pull and lift the paper feed roller slightly to remove it, and then remove the protective
sheet.
8. With the roller part facing downwards, insert the ends of the paper feed roller shaft to
return the paper feed roller to its original position.
M160/M161 2-14 SM
Main Machine Installation
Installation
10. Open Tray 1, and remove the protective materials.
SM 2-15 M160/M161
Main Machine Installation
Loading Paper
1. Check that paper in the paper tray is not being used, and then pull out the paper tray
carefully. Adjust the paper size dial to match the size and feed direction of the paper in
the paper tray.
2. Pull the tray carefully until it stops, lift the front side of the tray, and then pull it out of
the machine.
3. Squeezing the releases on the side and end paper guides, adjust the guides’ positions
according to the size of paper to be loaded.
4. Load the paper, insert the tray while keeping its front slightly raised, and then push it in
all the way in.
M160/M161 2-16 SM
Main Machine Installation
Installation
2. Press [Printer Features].
3. Press [List / Test Print].
4. Press [Configuration Page].
5. Press the [User Tools/Counter] key.
After setting up the machine, configure the hard disk overwriting and data encryption
settings. (page 2-73 "Data Overwrite Security", page 2-75 "HDD Encryption")
SM 2-17 M160/M161
Main Machine Installation
It is dangerous to handle the power cord plug with wet hands. Doing so could result in
electric shock.
Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet before you move the machine. While moving
the machine, take care that the power cord is not damaged under the machine. Failing to
take these precautions could result in fire or electric shock.
If you have to move the machine when the optional paper tray unit is attached, do not
push on the main unit's top section. Doing so can cause the optional paper tray unit to
detach, possibly resulting in injury.
When disconnecting the power cord from the wall outlet, always pull the plug, not the
cord. Pulling the cord can damage the power cord. Use of damaged power cords could
result in fire or electric shock.
The machine weighs approximately 23 kg (50.7 lb.). When moving the machine, use the
inset grips on both sides, and lift slowly in pairs. The machine will break or cause injury if
dropped.
Do not hold the control panel while moving the machine. Doing so may damage the
control panel, cause a malfunction, or result in injury.
M160/M161 2-18 SM
Main Machine Installation
Installation
handling may cause a malfunction or damage the hard disk or memory, resulting in loss
of stored files.
1. Be sure to check the following:
The main power switch is turned off.
The power cord is unplugged from the wall outlet.
The interface cable is unplugged from the machine.
2. If any external options are attached, remove them.
3. Lift the machine using the inset grips on both sides of the machine, and then move it
horizontally to the place where you want to use it.
4. If you removed options, reattach them.
Be sure to move the machine horizontally. To prevent toner from scattering, move the
machine slowly.
SM 2-19 M160/M161
Paper Feed Unit PB1060/ Paper Feed Unit PB1070
PB1070
When lifting the machine, use the inset grips on both sides. The machine could break or
cause an injury if dropped.
1 Installation Procedure 1
1 Installation Procedure 1
M160/M161 2-20 SM
Paper Feed Unit PB1060/ Paper Feed Unit PB1070
Turn off the main power switch of the machine and unplug the power cord before you
start the installation procedure.
Installation
To attach two lower paper trays at the same time, first stack them one upon the other, and
then attach them as a single unit.
1. Remove the packaging from the lower paper tray.
2. Lift the machine slowly using the inset grips on both sides, and then position it
immediately above the lower paper tray.
3. There are three upright pins on the optional lower paper tray. Align them with the holes
on the underside of the machine, and then carefully lower the machine.
Check "Attached Equipment" on the configuration page. If the tray was attached correctly,
"Tray 2" and "Tray 3" will appear.
SM 2-21 M160/M161
Controller Options
2.4.1 OVERVIEW
Always touch a grounded surface to discharge static electricity from your hands before
you handle SD cards, printed circuit boards, or memory boards.
The machine is equipped with a USB host interface, I/F card slot, and SD card slots for controller
options.
M160/M161 2-22 SM
SD Card Appli Move
2.5.1 OVERVIEW
Since there are only two SD card slots (one of them is a service slot), three or more SD card
Installation
applications cannot be used simultaneously.
However, if multiple SD card applications are merged, three or more SD card options can be
used.
This function is referred to as the “SD card merge function.”
The “SD card merge function” is a function which enables the use of three or more functions
within the capacity of two SD cards by physically transferring the function of one SD card to other
SD cards (all SD card options can be stored in two SD cards).
However, SD card applications are under license, therefore, since an SD card license after merge
is transferred to the target SD card, it cannot be used even if it is moved to the target machine.
Also, a process to prevent illegal copying is performed.
The service program "SD Card Appli Move" (SP5-873) lets you move application programs from
one SD card to another SD card.
SM 2-23 M160/M161
SD Card Appli Move
Movable to
Card Size Target
SD Card Option another SD Remarks
Capacity SD card
card
Both Slots 1 and 2 are vacant when the machine is shipped from the factory.
OCR Unit Type M2 cannot be moved to another SD card and is unavailable for target SD
card.
VM Card Type W cannot be moved to another SD card.
Do not turn ON the write protect switch of the system SD card or application SD card on
the machine. If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44)
occurs during a firmware upgrade or application merge.
1. Turn the main power switch off.
2. SD card slot cover [A].
M160/M161 2-24 SM
SD Card Appli Move
Installation
3. Make sure that a target SD card is in SD Card Slot 1 [A]. The application program is
moved to this SD card.
4. Insert the source SD card with the application program in SD Card Slot 2 [B]. The
application program is copied from this source SD card.
5. Turn the main power switch on.
6. Start the SP mode.
7. Select SP5-873-001 "Move Exec".
8. Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.
9. Turn the main power switch off.
10. Remove the source SD card from SD Card Slot 2 [B].
11. Attach the SD card slot cover.
12. Turn the main power switch on.
13. Check that the application programs run normally.
SM 2-25 M160/M161
SD Card Appli Move
Do not turn ON the write protect switch of the system SD card or application SD card on
the machine. If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44)
occurs during a firmware upgrade or application merge.
1. Turn the main power switch off.
2. SD card slot cover [A].
4. Insert the SD card which became empty after integration in Slot 2 [B].
5. Turn the main power switch on.
6. Start the SP mode.
M160/M161 2-26 SM
SD Card Appli Move
Installation
13. Check that the application has been deleted.
SM 2-27 M160/M161
IPDS Unit Type M6
1 SD Card: IPDS 1
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
1. Loosen the screw and remove the SD card slot cover at an angle.
2. Insert the SD card (IPDS Unit) in SD slot 1 (upper). Then push it slowly until it clicks.
3. Hook the SD card slot cover onto the opening, attach it flat against the controller board,
and then fasten it using the screw.
4. Plug in the power cord, and then turn on the machine.
5. Print the configuration page to confirm the installation (page 2-17 "Printing a
Configuration Page").
M160/M161 2-28 SM
IPDS Unit Type M6
Confirm that the IPDS was correctly installed by printing the configuration page. If it is
correctly installed, "IPDS Menu" will appear on the configuration page.
Installation
SM 2-29 M160/M161
SD card for NetWare printing Type M6
1 SD Card: NetWare 1
2 RoHS Decal 1
3 LABEL:ROHS:DATE:40MM 1
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
1. Loosen the screw and remove the SD card slot cover at an angle.
2. Insert the SD card (Netware Printing) in SD slot 1 (upper). Then push it slowly until it
clicks.
3. Hook the SD card slot cover onto the opening, attach it flat against the controller board,
and then fasten it using the screw.
M160/M161 2-30 SM
SD card for NetWare printing Type M6
Confirm that the NetWare was correctly installed by printing the configuration page. If it is
correctly installed, "NetWare" will appear for "Interface Information" on the configuration
Installation
page.
SM 2-31 M160/M161
Browser Unit Type M6
The browser for these models is not installed in the SD card HDD, but in order to start up
using the data on the SD card, it must be operated with the SD card inserted.
The browser unit uses a native application such as a full browser in order to improve web
browsing.
Also, to provide a solution utilizing the web as in previous machines, Extended JavaScript is also
provided as an ESA application.
Due to the above, the browser unit for this model has two firmware modules, native application
firmware, and Type-C application EXJS firmware.
M160/M161 2-32 SM
Browser Unit Type M6
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
1. Loosen the screw and remove the SD card slot cover at an angle.
Installation
2. Insert the Browser Option SD card in SD slot 1 (upper). Then push it slowly until it
clicks.
SM 2-33 M160/M161
Browser Unit Type M6
6. Make sure that “Extended JS” application was automatically installed in the Startup
Settings tab.
7. Turn the main power switch OFF/ON.
8. Push the [User Tools/Counter] key.
9. Touch "Edit Home”.
M160/M161 2-34 SM
Browser Unit Type M6
Installation
13. Touch "Browser”.
SM 2-35 M160/M161
Browser Unit Type M6
The Browser Unit consists of the Browser firmware and EXJS firmware. The EXJS
firmware is equivalent to the existing browser firmware. Therefore, it is possible to update
the EXJS firmware using the same procedure as that of SDK application firmware.
M160/M161 2-36 SM
Browser Unit Type M6
Preparation
1. Extract the exe file (XXXX. exe), after which the following two files are generated:
XXXX_machine. exe/ XXXX_stock.exe.
Note: The file (XXXX_machine) is for updating the EXJS firmware in the field.
Installation
2. Extract the file (XXXX_machine), after which the “SDK” folder is created.
Main procedure
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
1. Loosen the screw and remove the SD card slot cover at an angle.
2. Insert the SD card included for firmware update into SD slot 2 (lower). Then push it
slowly until it clicks.
SM 2-37 M160/M161
Browser Unit Type M6
4. Change the status of “Extended JS” to “Ending” in the Startup Settings tab.
5. Turn the main power switch OFF.
6. Insert the SD card containing the Extended JS firmware into SD slot 2 (lower).
7. Turn the main power switch on.
8. Push the [User Tools/Counter] key.
9. Touch "Extended Feature Settings" twice on the LCD.
10. Touch the “Install” tab.
11. Touch “SD card”, then select “Extended JS” from the list of Extended Features.
12. Select “Machine HDD” as the “Install to” destination, then touch “Next”.
13. Check the Extended Features information on the “Ready to Install” screen, then press
“OK”.
14. After “The following extended feature has already been installed. Are you sure you
want to overwrite it?” is displayed, press “Yes”.
15. Change the status of Extended JS to “waiting” in the Startup Settings tab.
16. Turn the main power switch OFF.
17. Remove the SD card from slot 2 (lower slot).
18. Turn the main power switch ON.
M160/M161 2-38 SM
Browser Unit Type M6
Installation
2.8.7 UN-INSTALLING EXJS FIRMWARE
1. Turn the main power switch ON.
2. Push the [User Tools/Counter] key.
3. Login with an administrator user name and password.
4. Touch "Extended Feature Settings" twice on the LCD.
5. Touch “Uninstall”.
6. Touch “Browser”, and then touch “Yes” after “Are you sure you want to uninstall the
following extended feature?” is displayed.
“Uninstalling the extended feature... Please wait” is then displayed on the touch
screen.
7. After "Completed" is displayed, turn the main power switch OFF.
The Browser firmware is un-installed from the machine when the Browser SD card is
removed.
SM 2-39 M160/M161
XPS Direct Print Option Type M6
1 SD Card: XPS 1
2 RoHS Decal 1
3 LABEL:ROHS:DATE:40MM 1
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
1. Loosen the screw and remove the SD card slot cover at an angle.
2. Insert the SD card (XPS Direct Print) in SD slot 1 (upper). Then push it slowly until it
clicks.
3. Hook the SD card slot cover onto the opening, attach it flat against the controller board,
and then fasten it using the screw.
M160/M161 2-40 SM
XPS Direct Print Option Type M6
Confirm that the XPS was correctly installed by printing the configuration page. If it is
correctly installed, "XPS Menu" will appear on the configuration page.
Installation
SM 2-41 M160/M161
VM Card Type W
1 SD Card: VM Card 1
4. Insert the SD card (VM Card) in SD slot 1 (upper). Then push it slowly until it clicks.
M160/M161 2-42 SM
VM Card Type W
5. Hook the SD card slot cover onto the opening, attach it flat against the controller board,
and then fasten it using the screw.
6. Plug in the power cord, and then turn on the machine.
When you insert the SD card and turn the main power switch on, installation of Java TM
Platform starts automatically. Automatic installation takes approximately three minutes.
Installation
If you turn the power off during installation, the VM card may be damaged. Be sure to
check the following before turning the power off.
7. Press [User Tools/Counter] key, and then press [Extended Features].
If installation has completed correctly, [JavaTM Platform] appears in the Extended Features
menu.
8. Press [Exit] twice to exit from the Extended Features menu.
Operate the machine with the VM card installed in SD Card Slot 1 (upper).
If you have changed the [Sleep Mode Timer] setting in Step 1, change the setting
back to the previous one once installation is complete.
SM 2-43 M160/M161
OCR Unit Type M2
With this option, you can add the Searchable PDF function to the scanning function. After
installing the function on the hard disk from the SD card, remove the SD card.
1 SD Card: OCR 1
M160/M161 2-44 SM
OCR Unit Type M2
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
1. Loosen the screw and remove the SD card slot cover at an angle.
Installation
2. Insert the SD card (OCR Unit) in SD slot 2 (lower). Then push it slowly until it clicks.
If the execution failed, the display tells you that the execution failed.
If the execution failed, do the following.
Check if the SD card is already used.
Check whether the SD card has been used with another MFP (whether the OCR unit
in the SD card has been installed in another MFP).
Turn off the main power switch, and do steps 1 to 5 again.
6. Turn the main power switch off and on.
7. Go to SP 5-878-004 (Option Setup: OCR) and press [EXECUTE].
The OCR dictionary is copied to the HDD from the SD card.
SM 2-45 M160/M161
OCR Unit Type M2
SP 5-878-004 links the SD card and the machine in the first execution, and then
copies the OCR dictionary to the HDD in the second execution.
8. Turn off the main power switch, and then remove the SD card form the SD card slot.
9. Re-attach the SD card slot cover.
10. Turn on the main power switch.
11. Press [Send Settings] on the [Scanner] screen.
12. Press [File Type], and then press [PDF File Type].
13. Check if [OCR Settings] is displayed on the [PDF File Type] screen.
Keep the empty card in place by, for example, affixing it near the SD card slot with
adhesive tape.
You can switch the searchable PDF function on and off in the [OCR Settings] screen after
installing the OCR unit.
If you want to use the searchable PDF function, select [On] for [OCR Settings]. (Default:
[Off])
Restoration Procedure
When you install the OCR Unit Type M2, the searchable PDF function is saved on the HDD and
the SD card ID is saved in NVRAM.
Therefore, you need to re-install the OCR Unit Type M2 after replacing the HDD or NVRAM.
When the original SD card exists
When you replace the HDD
Re-install the OCR Unit Type M2 from the original SD card.
When you replace the NVRAM
If you upload / download the NVRAM data, re-install the OCR Unit Type M2 from the
original SD card.
If you don’t upload / download the NVRAM data, order a new SD card (service part) of the
OCR Unit Type M2. Then re-install the OCR Unit Type M2 from the new SD card.
When you replace the HDD and NVRAM at the same time
Re-install the OCR Unit Type M2 from the original SD card.
M160/M161 2-46 SM
OCR Unit Type M2
When you re-install the OCR Unit Type M2, do the same procedure as the original
installation procedure.
Installation
SM 2-47 M160/M161
Memory Unit Type M1 1.5GB
1 SDRAM module 1
3 LABEL:ROHS:CHN:DATE:40MM 1
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
Before beginning work, ground yourself by touching something metal to discharge any
static electricity. Static electricity can damage the memory unit.
1. Remove the memory cover.
2. Loosen the screw by using a coin, and then slide the inner cover towards the front to
remove it.
M160/M161 2-48 SM
Memory Unit Type M1 1.5GB
3. Push the levers on both ends of the slot outward, and then remove the default module.
Installation
4. To install the recommended memory, align the notch of the recommended memory
with the protruding part of the vacant slot, and then carefully insert the module at an
angle.
5. Keeping the module at an angle, press it down until it clicks into place.
6. When also installing the hard disk, install it before returning the inner cover to the
machine.
For instructions about installing the hard disk, see page 2-51 "Hard Disk Drive Option Type
M6".
SM 2-49 M160/M161
Memory Unit Type M1 1.5GB
7. Insert the two left protrusions of the inner cover, and then insert the two right
protrusions into the notches on the machine.
Confirm that the SDRAM module was correctly installed by printing the configuration
page. Check that the total memory value is shown in "Total Memory" on the configuration
page.
M160/M161 2-50 SM
Hard Disk Drive Option Type M6
Installation
No. Description Q'ty
1 Hard disk 1
2 CABLE:HDD:SATA:RED:102 1
3 CABLE:HDD:SATA:POWER_3P:70 1
4 KNOB SCREW:M3 2
- SHEET:EMC:ADDRESS:TAI 1
- DECAL:DOC:NA 1
- DECAL:DOC:EU 1
- DECAL:DOC:CHN 1
- RoHS Decal 1
- LABEL:ROHS:DATE:40MM 1
Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
1. Remove the memory cover.
SM 2-51 M160/M161
Hard Disk Drive Option Type M6
2. Loosen the screw by using a coin, and then slide the inner cover towards the front to
remove it.
3. Connect the flat cable and power cord to the hard disk.
M160/M161 2-52 SM
Hard Disk Drive Option Type M6
Installation
5. Connect the flat cable and power cord to the board of the machine.
6. Install the hard disk, and then fasten the hard disk to the machine with the screws.
7. Insert the two left protrusions of the inner cover, and then insert the two right
protrusions into the notches on the machine.
SM 2-53 M160/M161
Hard Disk Drive Option Type M6
Confirm that the hard disk was correctly installed by printing the configuration page. If it is
correctly installed, "Hard Disk" will appear for "Device Connection" on the configuration
page.
M160/M161 2-54 SM
File Format Converter Type E
Installation
No. Description Q'ty
1 PCB Unit 1
2 RoHS Decal 1
3 LABEL:ROHS:CHN:DATE:40MM 1
4 SHEET:FCC:CLASS_B:VERIFICATION 1
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
Before beginning work, ground yourself by touching something metal to discharge any
static electricity. Static electricity can damage the file format converter.
1. Loosen the two screws and remove the slot cover.
The removed cover will not be reused.
SM 2-55 M160/M161
File Format Converter Type E
M160/M161 2-56 SM
IEEE 1284 Interface Board Type A
Installation
No. Description Q'ty
1 PCB Unit 1
2 SHEET:UL:PERMISSION 1
3 SHEET:FCCDOC:IEEE1284(TYPE_A) 1
4 RoHS Decal 1
5 RoHS Sheet 1
6 LABEL:ROHS:DATE:40MM 1
CAUTION CHART:INSTALLATION
7 1
PROCEDURE:14LANGUAGES
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
Before beginning work, ground yourself by touching something metal to discharge any
static electricity. Static electricity can damage the interface board.
You can only install one of the following network interfaces at a time: (IEEE 802.11 a/b/g/n
(Wireless LAN), IEEE1284)
1. Loosen the two screws and remove the slot cover.
The removed cover will not be reused.
SM 2-57 M160/M161
IEEE 1284 Interface Board Type A
Confirm that the IEEE 1284 I/F board was correctly installed by printing the configuration
page. If it is correctly installed, "Parallel Interface" will appear for "Device Connection" on
the configuration page.
M160/M161 2-58 SM
IEEE802.11 Interface Unit Type O
Installation
No. Description Q’ty
1 PCB Unit 1
2 SHEET:CEDOC:W-LAN 1
3 SHEET:CAUTION CHART:W-LAN:AUS:NZL 1
4 SHEET:CAUTION CHART:W-LAN:CAN 1
5 SHEET:CAUTION CHART:USERS:W-LAN 1
6 SHEET:CAUTION CHART:W-LAN:GB 1
8 SHEET:FCCDOC:W-LAN:R-CMN-851 1
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
Before beginning work, ground yourself by touching something metal to discharge any
static electricity. Static electricity can damage the interface unit.
You can only install one of the following network interfaces at a time: (IEEE 802.11 a/b/g/n
(Wireless LAN), IEEE1284)
1. Loosen the two screws and remove the slot cover.
The removed cover will not be reused.
SM 2-59 M160/M161
IEEE802.11 Interface Unit Type O
Confirm that the Wireless LAN board was correctly installed by printing the configuration
page. If it is correctly installed, "Wireless LAN" will appear for "Device Connection" on the
configuration page.
You may have to move the machine if the reception is not clear.
Make sure that the machine is not located near an appliance or any type of equipment
that generates strong magnetic fields.
Install the machine as close as possible to the access point.
Select "Interface Settings"> "Network" > "LAN Type". The "LAN Type” (default:
Ethernet) must be set for either Ethernet or wireless LAN.
3. Select [Interface Settings].
4. Press "Wireless LAN". Only the wireless LAN options show.
5. Press "Communication Mode". Select either "802.11 Ad-Hoc Mode", or "Infrastructure
Mode".
6. Press "SSID Setting". Enter the SSID setting. (The setting is case sensitive.)
7. Press "Ad-HocChannel". You need this setting when Ad Hoc Mode is selected.
M160/M161 2-60 SM
IEEE802.11 Interface Unit Type O
Installation
8. Set the "Security Method" to specify the encryption of the Wireless LAN.
• The "WEP" (Wired Equivalent Privacy) setting is designed to protect wireless data
transmission. The same WEP key is required on the receiving side in order to unlock encoded
data. There are 64 bit and 128 bit WEP keys.
• Range of Allowed Settings:
64 bit: 10 characters
128 bit: 26 characters
• Specify "WPA2" when "Communication Mode" is set to "Infrastructure Mode". Set the
"WPA2 Authent. Method".
• WPA2 Authent. Method:
Select either "WPA2-PSK" or "WPA2".
If you select "WPA2-PSK", enter the pre-shared key (PSK) of 8-63 characters in ASCII code.
When "WPA2" is selected, authentication settings and certificate installation settings are
required.
9. Press "Wireless LAN Signal" to check the machine's radio wave status using the
operation panel.
You can check the status only if [Communication Mode] is set to [Infrastructure Mode].
10. Press "Restore Factory Defaults" to initialize the wireless LAN settings.
SM 2-61 M160/M161
IEEE802.11 Interface Unit Type O
5840-011 WEP Key Select Used to select the WEP key (Default: 00).
M160/M161 2-62 SM
Bluetooth Interface Unit Type D
Installation
No. Description Q’ty
1 Bluetooth Module 1
2 CD-ROM 1
4 SHEET:FCCDOC:BLUETOOTH 1
5 CAUTION CHART:CE:BLUETOOTH 1
SM 2-63 M160/M161
Bluetooth Interface Unit Type D
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
Do not remove the Bluetooth unit while the power of the machine is on.
You can only install one of the following network interfaces at a time: (IEEE a/b/g/n (Wireless LAN),
Bluetooth).
1. Insert the Bluetooth Interface adapter into the USB connector .
Confirm that the Bluetooth interface unit was correctly installed by printing the
configuration page. If it is correctly installed, "Bluetooth" will appear for "Device
Connection" on the configuration page.
M160/M161 2-64 SM
Copy Data Security Unit Type G
Installation
No. Description Q’ty For this model
1 ICIB-3 1 Yes
2 BRACKET:ICIB 1 Yes
3 Screw – M3 x 6 4 Yes
5 Screw – M3 x 4 2 Yes
- LABEL:ROHS:DATE:40MM 1 Yes
SM 2-65 M160/M161
Copy Data Security Unit Type G
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
1. Attach bracket [A] to the ICIB-3 [B] (M3 x 4; x 2).
M160/M161 2-66 SM
Copy Data Security Unit Type G
Right Cover")
3. Mount Copy Data Security Unit [A] on the BICU board with the connector on the upper
right part aligned (M3 x 6; x 2).
Installation
SM 2-67 M160/M161
Copy Data Security Unit Type G
The machine will issue an SC165 error if the machine is powered on with the ICIB-1
removed and the "Detect Data Security for Copying" feature is set to "On".
When you remove this option from the machine, first set the setting to "OFF" with the
user tool before removing this board. If you forget to do this, "Detect Data Security for
Copying" feature cannot appear in the user tool settings. And then SC165 will appear
every time the machine is switched on, and the machine cannot be used.
M160/M161 2-68 SM
Data Overwrite Security Unit Type I
2.19.1 OVERVIEW
This option should be installed only for the customer who requires the CC certified Data
Installation
Overwrite Security function.
The function of this option is completely the same as the Data Overwrite Security in Security
Functions, which is standard on this machine.
1. SD Card 1
If you install any version other than "Type I", you will have to replace the NVRAM
and do this installation procedure again.
2. Make sure that the following settings are not at their factory default values:
Supervisor login password
Administrator login name
Administrator login password
If any of these settings is at a factory default value, tell the customer these settings must be
changed before you do the installation procedure.
3. Make sure that “Machine Management” is on.
SM 2-69 M160/M161
Data Overwrite Security Unit Type I
[System Settings] -> [Administrator Tools] -> [Administrator Authentication Management] ->
[Machine Management] -> [On]
If this setting is OFF, tell the customer this setting must be ON before you do the installation
procedure.
4. Make sure that “Administrator Tools” is enabled (selected).
[System Settings] -> [Administrator Tools] -> [Administrator Authentication Management] ->
[Machine Management] -> [On] -> [Select available settings]
If this setting is disabled (not selected), tell the customer this setting must be enabled
(selected) before you do the installation procedure.
You must check the box seals to make sure that they were not removed after the items
were sealed in the box at the factory before you do the installation.
1. Check the box seals [A] on each corner of the box.
Make sure that a tape is attached to each corner.
The surfaces of the tapes must be blank. If you see “VOID” on the tapes, do not install the
components in the box.
2. If the surfaces of the tapes do not show “VOID”, remove them from the corners of the box.
3. You can see the “VOID” marks [B] when you remove each seal. In this condition, they cannot
be attached to the box again.
M160/M161 2-70 SM
Data Overwrite Security Unit Type I
Installation
2. Install the application using SP5-878-001.
SM 2-71 M160/M161
Security Settings
This method is recommended because there is no user data on the hard drive yet
(Address Book data, image data, etc.).
If the customer wishes to activate the Data Overwrite Security and HDD Encryption unit on a
machine that is already running, it is recommended to activate the unit by selecting "All Data" from
“System Settings” on the operation panel.
Selecting "All Data" will preserve the data that has already been saved to the hard drive.
(If "Format All Data" is selected, all user data saved to the hard drive up to that point will
be erased).
Immediately after encryption is enabled, the encryption setting process will take several minutes
to complete before you can begin using the machine.
If encryption is enabled after data has been stored on the disk, or of the encryption key is
changed, this process can take up to three and a half hours or more.
The machine cannot be operated while data is being encrypted.
Once the encryption process begins, it cannot be stopped.
Make sure that the machine's main power is not turned off while the encryption process is in
progress.
If the machine's main power is turned off while the encryption process is in progress, the hard disk
will be damaged and all data on it will be unusable.
Print the encryption key and keep the encryption key (which is printed as a paper sheet).
Keep the encryption key in a safe place. If the encryption key is lost and is needed, the controller
board, hard disk and NVRAM must all be replaced at the same time.
M160/M161 2-72 SM
Security Settings
Installation
(3) Administrator login password
If any of these settings is at a factory default value, tell the customer these settings must be
changed before you do the installation procedure.
2. Make sure that “Machine Management” is on.
[User Tools/Counter] key -> [System Settings] -> [Administrator Tools] -> [Administrator
Authentication Management] -> [Machine Management] -> [On]
If this setting is off, tell the customer this setting must be on before you do the installation
procedure.
3. Make sure that “Administrator Tools” is enabled (selected).
[User Tools/Counter] key -> [System Settings] -> [Administrator Tools] -> [Administrator
Authentication Management] -> [Machine Management] -> [On] -> [Select available settings]
-> [Administrator Tools]
If this setting is disabled (not selected), tell the customer this setting must be enabled
(selected) before you do the installation procedure.
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the network cable if it needs to be connected.
2. Turn on the main power switch.
3. Go into the SP mode and push “EXECUTE” in SP5-878-001.
4. Exit the SP mode and turn off the main power switch.
5. Turn on the machine power.
6. Do SP5-990-005 (SP print mode Diagnostic Report).
7. Go into the User Tools mode, and select [System Settings] - [Administrator Tools] - [Auto
Erase Memory Setting] - [On].
8. Exit the User Tools mode.
SM 2-73 M160/M161
Security Settings
6. Press [On].
7. Select the method of overwriting.
If you select [NSA] or [DoD], proceed to step 10.
If you select [Random Numbers], proceed to step 8.
8. Enter the number of times that you want to overwrite using the number keys, and then press
[#].
9. Press [OK]. Auto Erase Memory is set.
10. Log out.
11. Check the display and make sure that the overwrite erase icon appears.
12. Check the overwrite erase icon.
The icon [1] is lit when there is temporary data to be overwritten, and blinks during
overwriting.
The icon [2] is lit when there is no temporary data to be overwritten.
M160/M161 2-74 SM
Security Settings
Installation
2.20.3 HDD ENCRYPTION
Installation Procedure
1. Turn on the main power switch, and then enter the SP mode.
2. Select SP5878-002, and then press "Execute" on the LCD.
3. Exit the SP mode after "Completed" is displayed on the LCD.
4. Turn off the main power switch.
SM 2-75 M160/M161
Security Settings
When setting up encryption, specify whether to start encryption after deleting data
(initialize) or encrypt and retain existing data. If data is retained, it may take some time to
encrypt it.
1. Log in as the machine administrator from the control panel.
2. Press [System Settings].
3. Press [Administrator Tools].
4. Press [ ] to display Page 11.
5. Press [Machine Data Encryption Settings].
6. Press [Encrypt].
7. Select the data to be carried over to the hard disk and not be reset.
To carry all of the data over to the hard disk, select [All Data].
To carry over only the machine settings data, select [File System Data Only].
To reset all of the data, select [Format All Data].
8. Select the backup method.
If you have selected [Save to SD], load an SD card into the media slot on the side of the
control panel and press [OK] to back up the machine's data encryption key.
If you have selected [Print on Ppr], press the [Start] key. Print out the machine's data
encryption key.
M160/M161 2-76 SM
Security Settings
9. Press [OK].
10. Press [Exit].
11. Press [Exit]
12. Log out.
13. Turn off the main power switch, and then turn the main power switch back on.
Installation
The machine will start to convert the data on the memory after you turn on the machine. Wait
until the message "Memory conversion complete. Turn the main power switch off." appears,
and then turn the main power switches off again.
Check the Encryption Settings
1. Press the [User Tools/Counter] key.
2. Press [System Settings].
3. Press [Administrator Tools].
4. Press [Machine Data Encryption Settings].
5. If the following message appears, the encryption settings have been enabled.
“The data in the machine has been encrypted. Select item.”
The encryption key is required for data recovery if the machine malfunctions. Be sure to
store the encryption key safely for retrieving backup data.
1. Log in as the machine administrator from the control panel.
2. Press [System Settings].
3. Press [Administrator Tools].
4. Press [ ] to display Page 11.
5. Press [Machine Data Encryption Settings].
6. Press [Print Encryption Key].
7. Select the backup method.
If you have selected [Save to SD], load an SD card into the media slot on the side of the
control panel and press [OK]; once the machine's data encryption key is backed up, press
[Exit].
If you have selected [Print on Ppr], press the [Start] key. Print out the machine's data
encryption key.
8. Press [Exit].
9. Log out.
SM 2-77 M160/M161
Security Settings
Ask an Administrator to enter the encryption key. The key has already been
printed out by the user and may have been saved in the "key_xxxxxxxxxxx.txt"
file. (The function of back-up the encryption key to the SD card directly is
provided 11A products or later.)
5. Turn on the machine’s main power switch.
6. Confirm that a message is displayed on the LCD telling to insert the SD card that
contains the encryption key.
7. Turn off the main power switch.
8. Insert the SD card that contains the encryption key into Slot 2 (the lower slot).
9. Turn on the main power switch.
The machine will automatically restore the encryption key to the flash memory
on the controller board.
10. Turn off the main power switch when the machine has returned to normal status.
11. Remove the SD card from Slot 2.
M160/M161 2-78 SM
Security Settings
Installation
User settings will be cleared.
1. Prepare an SD card.
2. Create a directory named “restore_key” inside the root directory of the SD card. Then,
save the “nvram_key.txt” file using the following name:
/restore_key/nvram_key.txt
3. Create a text file and write "nvclear".
SM 2-79 M160/M161
Settings for @Remote Service
Prepare and check the following check points before you visit the customer site. For
details, ask the @Remote key person.
M160/M161 2-80 SM
Settings for @Remote Service
Installation
4. Check the confirmation result with SP5816-204.
0 Succeeded -
5. Make sure that the screen displays the Location Information with SP5816-205 only
when it has been input at the Center GUI.
6. Click [EXECUTE] to execute the registration with SP5816-206.
7. Check the registration result with SP5816-207.
SM 2-81 M160/M161
Settings for @Remote Service
0 Succeeded -
M160/M161 2-82 SM
Settings for @Remote Service
Installation
-12004 Attempted setting with illegal
Check ID2 of the
entries for certification and
mainframe.
ID2.
by Response Center
SM 2-83 M160/M161
Settings for @Remote Service
M160/M161 2-84 SM
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
Preventive Maintenance Tables
3. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
Maintenance
Preventive
SM 3-1 M160/M161
Image Quality Standards
Engine
Envelopes
Leading edge: 4.3 mm
Leading edge: 15 mm
Assured Image Area Left/Right: 4.3 mm
Left/Right: 10 mm
Trailing edge: 4.3 mm
Trailing edge: 15 mm
Copy
Envelopes
Leading edge: 4.3 mm
Leading edge: 15 mm
Assured Image Area Left/Right: 4.3 mm
Left/Right: 10 mm
Trailing edge: 4.3 mm
Trailing edge: 15 mm
M160/M161 3-2 SM
Image Quality Standards
100%
Main: ± 1.25% or less
Not applicable to the
Sub: ± 1.25% or less
back of the paper when
Magnification Error Reduced-size
performing duplex
Both: ± 1.25% or less
printing.
Enlarged-size
Both: ± 1.25% or less
Maintenance
Preventive
Perpendicularity
± 2.4 mm/200 mm or less
ARDF
100% SEF:
± 1.75% or less
Magnification Error
Reduction/Enlargement SEF:
± 1.75% or less
To check whether the problem is with the image or is due to another issue, print the test
pattern.
SM 3-3 M160/M161
Paper Transfer Quality Standards
Engines
Single Side:
Main Scan: 0 ± 2.0 mm
Sub Scan: 0 ± 1.5 mm
Margin position Back of the paper when performing
duplex printing:
Main Scan: 0 ± 2.0 mm
Sub Scan: 0 ± 1.5 mm
M160/M161 3-4 SM
Paper Transfer Quality Standards
ARDF
Single Side:
± 2.0 mm/200 mm or less (B5 SEF or Paper thickness
more) (ream weight)
Skew ± 2.5 mm/200 mm or less (Less than Single Side: 45-110
Maintenance
Preventive
B5 SEF) kg
Duplex: Duplex: 45-90 kg
± 2.5 mm/100 mm or less
These standards are determined using standard paper under standard conditions.
Values may vary depending on environmental conditions such as temperature, humidity, use of
used paper, etc.
SM 3-5 M160/M161
REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
General Cautions
and Adjustment
The push switch in this machine uses DC (direct current). Therefore, if the AC power cord is
Replacement
connected to an electrical outlet, power is supplied to the controller board, the operation unit
and other modules even when the main power is turned OFF. When replacing the controller
board and the operation unit in this state, not only these boards, it will damage other electrical
components.
So, when performing maintenance work such as replacing parts, in addition to turning off the
main power with the push switch, always unplug the AC power cord.
When you disconnect the power cord from the AC wall outlet, inside the machine there is
still residual charge.
When you disconnect the power cord from the AC wall outlet, inside the machine for a while
there is still residual charge. Therefore, if you remove boards in this state, it can cause a
blown fuse or memory failure.
--How to remove the residual charge inside the machine--
After you unplug the power cord from the AC wall outlet, in order to remove the residual
charge from inside the machine, be sure to press the main power switch. Thus, the charge
remaining in the machine is released, and it is possible to remove boards.
When you reconnect the AC power cord into an AC wall outlet, the machine will start
automatically.
In order to remove the residual charge, push the main power switch while you disconnect the
AC power cord. At that time, the power ON flag inside the machine is set. Therefore, after you
finish work on the machine and reconnect the power cord to the AC, even if you do not press
the main power switch, the machine will start automatically and the moving parts will begin to
move. When working on moving parts, be careful that fingers or clothes do not get caught.
SM 4-1 M160/M161
General Cautions
Automatic restart deals with cases when you accidentally unplugged the AC power cord
or unexpected power outages. By keeping the power flag ON, after the resumption of
power, the machine will start up automatically.
In rare cases, when you reconnect the AC power cord to a power outlet, the machine does not
start automatically. In this case, the machine has not failed. The cause is due to the timing of
releasing the residual charge. If you press the main power switch while the residual charge was
already released, the power ON flag will not be set. At this time, start the machine manually by
pressing the main power switch.
Shutdown Method
1. Press the main power switch [A] on the left side of the machine.
After the shutdown process, the main power is turned off automatically.
When the shutdown is complete
Main power LED: Off
Operation panel LED: Off
2. Take out the power cord.
3. Wait 3 minutes (this is the time required if you will remove the rear cover and access
the interior of the machine, to take out the controller board for example).
Note: If some LEDs on any of the boards are blinking or lit, current is still flowing.
How to start from shutdown
To start the machine, press the main power switch. However, if you press the main power
switch between the beginning and the end of a shutdown, the machine will not start.
M160/M161 4-2 SM
General Cautions
Forced Shutdown
In case normal shutdown does not complete for some reason, the machine has a forced shutdown
function.
To make a forced shutdown, press and hold the main power switch for 6 seconds.
In general, do not use the forced shutdown.
Forced shutdown may damage the hard disk and memory, and can cause damage to the
machine. Use a forced shutdown only if it is unavoidable.
and Adjustment
Replacement
SM 4-3 M160/M161
Special Tools
A PC (Personal Computer) is required for creating the Encryption key file on an SD card
when replacing the controller board for a model in which HDD encryption has been
enabled.
M160/M161 4-4 SM
Exterior Covers
and Adjustment
Replacement
4. ( x2) on the by-pass tray [A].
5. Release the both end hinges of the by-pass tray [A] to detach it.
To remove the by-pass tray, lift the left hinge first to release while raising the by-pass
tray upwards.
The left hinge is C-cut.
SM 4-5 M160/M161
Exterior Covers
6. ( x1) on the front cover [A] in order to remove the strap that ties the front cover to the
machine.
7. Open the front cover [A] and release the strap [B].
Release the left hinge [B] first to detach the front cover.
M160/M161 4-6 SM
Exterior Covers
There are three tabs on the back of the left cover. Refer to the picture below.
and Adjustment
Replacement
2. Open the Rear Cover.
3. Left Cover [A] ( x4, Hook x3)
SM 4-7 M160/M161
Exterior Covers
There are four tabs on the back of the right cover. Refer to the picture below.
M160/M161 4-8 SM
Exterior Covers
and Adjustment
Replacement
4. Rear Lower Cover [A]
SM 4-9 M160/M161
Exterior Covers
M160/M161 4-10 SM
Exterior Covers
and Adjustment
Replacement
SM 4-11 M160/M161
Exterior Covers
M160/M161 4-12 SM
LED Optics
Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord before you start any of the
procedures in this section.
Be sure to clean the lens of the LED head after replacing the LED unit or if you
inadvertently touch the lens when replacing another unit.
1. PCDU (page 4-20 "PCDU")
2. Upper Cover (page 4-10 "Upper Cover")
and Adjustment
3. Duct [A] (Hook x 12)
Replacement
4. Upper Inner Cover [A] ( x2, Hook x3)
SM 4-13 M160/M161
LED Optics
7. Remove the spacer [A], ground wire [B], and flat cable [C] from the LED unit.
The spacer [A] has a protruding part that engages with the groove in the shaft to
secure the spacer. When you remove the spacer, pull its handle downward as if to
rotate the spacer slightly.
M160/M161 4-14 SM
LED Optics
8. Slightly flex the side plates outward and pull the LED unit [A] out of the machine.
and Adjustment
Replacement
When you attach the LED unit, engage the LED unit's shaft ends (on the upper part)
with the holes in the LED unit holder. Be careful not to force the LED unit in. Doing so
may cause the LED unit holder's springs to come off.
9. Bend the stay [A] to release the left and right tabs, and then separate the stay from the
LED head [B].
SM 4-15 M160/M161
LED Optics
10. Remove the two spring holders [B] from the LED head [A].
M160/M161 4-16 SM
LED Optics
and Adjustment
Hook correctly engaged [B]
Replacement
If the hook is engaged correctly, the LED unit holder is raised to the front by the spring.
Right side
1. Remove the right cover, and then remove the gear unit. (page 4-26 "Gear Unit")
2. Loosen the screws on the cover [A]. ( x3).
Be sure to loosen the screws holding the cover [A] just enough to insert tweezers or
a screwdriver into the gap. Do not actually remove the screws.
SM 4-17 M160/M161
LED Optics
3. Insert tweezers or a screwdriver into the gap between the cover [A] and frame and
re-engage the spring hook [B] in the correct position.
Left side
1. Remove the left cover, and then raise the spring using tweezers or a screwdriver
inserted through the gap at the lower right of the spring [A].
M160/M161 4-18 SM
LED Optics
2. You can check the position of the hook [A] through the guide of the LED unit. Using
tweezers or a screwdriver, re-engage the hook in the correct position.
and Adjustment
Replacement
SM 4-19 M160/M161
PCDU
4.5 PCDU
4.5.1 PCDU
1. Open the front cover [A].
M160/M161 4-20 SM
Toner Cartridge
and Adjustment
Replacement
The release lever works in two steps. To release the lock, push down the release
lever to the horizontal position.
SM 4-21 M160/M161
Image Transfer
M160/M161 4-22 SM
Drive Unit
Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord before you start any of the
procedures in this section.
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.8.2 DUPLEX EXIT MOTOR
1. Upper Cover (page 4-10 "Upper Cover")
2. Duplex Exit Motor [A] ( x2, x1, x1)
SM 4-23 M160/M161
Drive Unit
5. All things attached to the toner supply clutch [A]. (Gear x1, Shaft x1)
M160/M161 4-24 SM
Drive Unit
and Adjustment
4.8.5 PAPER FEED CLUTCH
Replacement
1. BICU (page 4-61 "BICU")
2. Paper Feed Clutch [A] ( x1)
SM 4-25 M160/M161
Drive Unit
M160/M161 4-26 SM
Drive Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.8.9 RELAY CLUTCH
1. By-pass Feed Unit (page 4-41 "By-pass Feed Unit")
2. Gear Unit (page 4-26 "Gear Unit")
3. Relay Clutch [A] ( x1)
SM 4-27 M160/M161
Drive Unit
M160/M161 4-28 SM
Drive Unit
and Adjustment
Replacement
4. Junction Gate Solenoid [A] ( x2, Spring x1)
SM 4-29 M160/M161
Fusing
4.9 FUSING
Because there is a danger of burns on contact with hot parts of the fusing unit, start work
when the temperature drops to a low enough temperature.
Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord before you start any of the
procedures in this section. (page 4-1 "General Cautions")
M160/M161 4-30 SM
Fusing
and Adjustment
Replacement
When reassembling, be sure to attach the pin [A] to the correct position. If not, the
fusing unit cannot be attached to the main body properly.
3. Separate the fusing unit into the upper and lower fusing units.
4. Right cover [A] ( x2)
SM 4-31 M160/M161
Fusing
You can rejoin the upper and lower fusing units with more ease by lowering the envelope
lever.
M160/M161 4-32 SM
Fusing
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. Separate the fusing unit into the upper and lower fusing units. (page 4-31 "Upper
Fusing Unit / Lower Fusing Unit")
2. Cover [A] ( x1)
SM 4-33 M160/M161
Fusing
M160/M161 4-34 SM
Fusing
4.9.5 THERMOSTAT
1. Separate the fusing unit into the upper and lower fusing units. (page 4-31 "Upper
and Adjustment
Replacement
Fusing Unit / Lower Fusing Unit")
2. Hot Roller (page 4-33 "Fusing Lamp / Hot Roller")
3. Thermostat [A] ( x2)
SM 4-35 M160/M161
Fusing
4.9.6 THERMISTOR
4. Remove the bracket of the drawer connector, and then remove the screws of the
thermistor. ( x3)
5. Thermistor [A]
M160/M161 4-36 SM
Fusing
and Adjustment
Replacement
Notes on reassembly
Be sure to attach the drawer connector with its protruding part [A] in the position shown below.
Insert the flat nut [A]. Be sure not to drop them during disassembly.
SM 4-37 M160/M161
Fusing
M160/M161 4-38 SM
Paper Feed
Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord before you start any of the
procedures in this section.
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.10.2 PAPER FEED ROLLER
1. Paper Feed Tray (page 4-39 "Paper Feed Tray")
2. Slide the lever [B] to the left to detach the paper feed roller [A].
SM 4-39 M160/M161
Paper Feed
M160/M161 4-40 SM
Paper Feed
and Adjustment
Replacement
Release the hook [A] and then insert a flat-blade screwdriver into the space [B] to
detach the by-pass feed unit from the machine.
SM 4-41 M160/M161
Paper Feed
4. Slide the by-pass feed guide [A] with the by-pass feed roller to the right to detach it
from the machine.
M160/M161 4-42 SM
Paper Feed
5. Detach the by-pass feed roller with the shaft [B] from the guide [A].
6. Separate the bypass feed roller [A] from the shaft (Hook x1)
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.10.7 BY-PASS FRICTION PAD
1. By-pass Feed Unit (page 4-41 "By-pass Feed Unit")
2. Bottom Plate [A]
If you cannot remove the bottom plate because the part [A] prevents the cam [B] from
releasing, rotate the shaft [C] to let the cam [B] avoid the bottom plate link [A].
SM 4-43 M160/M161
Paper Feed
3. Push the friction pad [A] down to detach it. (Spring x1)
3. Detach the By-pass Paper End Sensor [A] from the bracket. (Hook)
M160/M161 4-44 SM
Paper Feed
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.10.10 PAPER SIZE DETECTION SWITCH
1. Right Cover (page 4-8 "Right Cover")
2. Bracket with Paper Size Detection Switch [A] ( x4, x1)
3. Detach the Paper Size Detection Switch [A] from the bracket. (Hook x2)
SM 4-45 M160/M161
Paper Feed
M160/M161 4-46 SM
Paper Transport
Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord before you start any of the
procedures in this section.
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.11.2 PAPER OVERFLOW SENSOR
1. Upper Cover (page 4-10 "Upper Cover")
2. Paper Overflow Sensor [A] ( x1, Hook)
SM 4-47 M160/M161
Paper Transport
5. Release the linking part to remove duplex exit guide unit [A].
M160/M161 4-48 SM
Paper Transport
and Adjustment
Replacement
4.11.5 REGISTRATION ROLLER (DRIVEN)
1. Drive Unit (page 4-26 "Drive Unit")
2. Gear Unit (page 4-26 "Gear Unit")
3. Paper Size Detection Switch (page 4-45 "Paper Size Detection Switch")
4. Registration Sensor (page 4-51 "Registration Sensor")
5. HVPS with bracket (page 4-66 "HVPS with Bracket")
6. Release the bearing [A] ×1 at the left end of the registration roller (drive) and fixing
plate[B] ×1. ( x1, ×2)
7. Release the bearing at the right end of the registration roller (drive), and remove the
grounding plate [A]. ( x 1, x 1)
SM 4-49 M160/M161
Paper Transport
8. Insert a flathead screwdriver into the gap on the left of the registration roller guide to
release the protruding part.
9. Release the harness from the guide [A] to detach the guide [A] with the registration
roller (driven).
10. Detach the registration roller (driven) [B] from the guide [A].
M160/M161 4-50 SM
Paper Transport
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. PCDU (page 4-20 "PCDU")
2. Sheet [A]
3. Release the hooks of the harness cover [A] with a screwdriver to remove it.
SM 4-51 M160/M161
Paper Transport
M160/M161 4-52 SM
Electrical Components
Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord before you start any of the
procedures in this section.
and Adjustment
Replacement
4. Remove the five screws of the bracket [A] ( x 5), then remove the FCU board [B] with
bracket ( x 1, x 1)
5. Detach the brackets [B] and [C] from the FCU board [A]. ( x3)
SM 4-53 M160/M161
Electrical Components
8. Mount the new FCU board in the machine by means of the bracket. ( x5, x1, x1)
9. Insert one end of the supplied flat cable into the CN603 connector on the new FCU
board.
Be careful not to insert the cable at an angle.
10. Insert the other end of the flat cable into the CN603 connector on the old FCU board.
Be careful not to insert the cable at an angle.
To prevent a short circuit, make sure the old FCU board does not come into contact
with anything metal.
11. Turn the main power switch on.
12. The SRAM data transfer begins. Transfer is complete when a beep sounds.
The volume of the beep is set to the same level as the speaker volume.
If the speaker volume is set to off, the volume of the beep is set to its initial
factory-set level.
If the machine does not beep, switch the main power off and then back on and try the
data transfer again. Try several times if necessary.
Be sure to check the transfer result after executing data transfer. If the transfer has
M160/M161 4-54 SM
Electrical Components
4.12.2 SPEAKER
1. Right Cover (page 4-8 "Right Cover")
2. Remove the five screws of the bracket [A] ( x 5), then remove the FCU board [B] with
and Adjustment
Replacement
bracket ( x 1, x 1)
SM 4-55 M160/M161
Electrical Components
4.12.3 PSU
1. Paper Feed Tray (page 4-39 "Paper Feed Tray")
2. Left Cover (page 4-7 "Left Cover")
3. Right Cover (page 4-8 "Right Cover")
4. Rear Cover (page 4-9 "Rear Cover / Rear Lower Cover")
5. Rear Lower Cover (page 4-9 "Rear Cover / Rear Lower Cover")
6. ( x3, x2, x2) on the left side of the PSU.
M160/M161 4-56 SM
Electrical Components
and Adjustment
Replacement
10. Cover [A] ( x2)
SM 4-57 M160/M161
Electrical Components
If you intend to replace the NVRAM, upload its contents to an SD card with SP5-824
before you remove NVRAM and replace it with a new one. Never remove the NVRAM
until after you have uploaded its contents.
Replacement Procedure
1. Controller Box (page 4-55 "Speaker")
2. Detach the controller board [A] by sliding it to the right. ( x4, x1).
3. Remove the NVRAM [C], the upper brace [A] and the lower brace [B].
M160/M161 4-58 SM
Electrical Components
and Adjustment
Replacement
Before replacing the controller board check which ESA applications have been
installed. After replacing the controller board, re-install the ESA applications by
following the installation instructions for each application.
After reinstalling the ESA applications, print the SMC (SP-5-990-024/025 (SMC:
SDK/ Application Info)).
4. If you have replaced the controller board, set the DIP switches on the new controller
board to the same settings as the old board.
SM 4-59 M160/M161
Electrical Components
Do all of the following if SP5-824-001 (NVRAM Data Upload) and SP5-825-001 (NVRAM
Data Download) cannot be performed for some reason.
1. Manually enter all data on the SMC report (factory settings).
2. Install the Security function (Data Overwrite Security and HDD Encryption unit) again.
M160/M161 4-60 SM
Electrical Components
4.12.6 BICU
1. Controller Board (page 4-58 "Controller Board")
2. BICU [A] ( x6, x all)
3. Remove the EEPROM [A] from the old board and install it on the new board.
and Adjustment
Replacement
Install so that the indentation [B] on EEPROM is facing the direction of the dent [C] that is
printed on the BICU board.
If the BICU serial number is not entered correctly, SC995-01 (serial number entry
error) appears.
6. Turn the main power switch off and on.
7. Set the DIP switches on the new BICU board to the same settings as the old board.
Make sure the EEPROM is correctly installed on the BICU. Insert the EEPROM in the
EEPROM slot with the "half-moon" pointing [C] to the downside.
SM 4-61 M160/M161
Electrical Components
Keep EEPROM away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static electricity
can damage EEPROM data.
1. Make sure that you have the SMC report (factory settings). This report comes with the
machine.
2. Print out the SMC data (SP5-990-001).
3. Turn the main power switch off.
4. Install an SD card into SD card slot 2. Then turn the main power on.
5. Copy the EEPROM data to an SD card (SP5-824-001) onto the SD card.
6. Turn off the main power switch. Then unplug the power cord.
7. Replace the EEPROM on the BICU and reassemble the machine.
8. Plug in the power cord. Then turn the main power switch on.
When you do this, SC995 will be displayed. However, DO NOT turn off the main power switch.
Continue with this procedure.
9. Copy the data from the SD card to the EEPROM (SP5-825-001).
10. Enter the BICU serial number.
11. Turn the main power switch off. Then remove the SD card from SD card slot 2.
12. Turn the main power switch on.
If the BICU serial number is not entered correctly, SC995-01 (serial number entry
error) appears.
13. Access SP5-996-001 and set the area code.
1 Japan
2 North America
3 EU
4 Taiwan
M160/M161 4-62 SM
Electrical Components
5 Asia
6 China
7 Korea
4.12.8 HDD
and Adjustment
1. Insert an SD card in SD card slot 2 (lower slot).
Replacement
2. Go into the SP mode.
3. Do SP5-846 51 to upload the address book data to the SD card.
Replacement Procedure
For details about the replacement procedure, see page 2-51 "Hard Disk Drive Option Type M6" in
2, "Installation".
If the HDD is damaged, you may not be able to retrieve this data from the HDD.
Never remove a used HDD unit from the work site (even if it is suspected of being
damaged) without the consent of the client.
The HDD must remain with the customer for disposal or safe keeping.
The HDD may contain proprietary or classified (Confidential, Secret) information.
Specifically, the HDD contains document server documents and data stored in temporary
files created automatically during copy job sorting and jam recovery. Such data is stored
on the HDD in a special format, so it cannot normally be read but it can possibly be
recovered with illegal methods.
SM 4-63 M160/M161
Electrical Components
Reinstallation
Explain to the customer that the following information stored on the HDD is lost when the
HDD is replaced: document server documents, document server address book.
The address book and document server documents (if needed) must be input again.
If the customer is using the Data Overwrite Security, the Data Encryption feature or OCR
Scanned PDF, these applications must be installed again.
M160/M161 4-64 SM
Electrical Components
4.12.10 HVPS
1. Left Cover (page 4-7 "
and Adjustment
Replacement
SM 4-65 M160/M161
Electrical Components
Left Cover")
2. HVPS [A] ( x4, x2, Tab x1)
M160/M161 4-66 SM
Electrical Components
Left Cover")
2. Toner End Sensor [B] and HVPS [A] with Bracket ( x5, x3, x2)
and Adjustment
Replacement
SM 4-67 M160/M161
Electrical Components
Left Cover")
2. Fusing Fan [A] ( x2, x1)
When you reattach the Fusing Fan, attach it correctly (as shown above, the face of
the fan with the sticker is on the outside).
4. Detach the PCDU Cooling Fan [A] from the bracket. ( x3)
M160/M161 4-68 SM
Electrical Components
When you reattach the PSU cooling fan, the face of the fan with the sticker must be on
the inside.
and Adjustment
Replacement
SM 4-69 M160/M161
Electrical Components
4.12.15 DC SWITCH
1. By-pass Feed Unit (page 4-41 "By-pass Feed Unit")
2. DC Switch [A] with Bracket ( x1)
M160/M161 4-70 SM
Electrical Components
and Adjustment
4.12.18 DIMM
Replacement
1. Cover [A]
3. DIMM [A]
SM 4-71 M160/M161
Electrical Components
M160/M161 4-72 SM
ARDF
4.13 ARDF
Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord before you start any of the
procedures in this section.
and Adjustment
Replacement
2. Scanner Rear Upper Cover [A]
SM 4-73 M160/M161
ARDF
The joint parts of the ARDF have tabs that latch onto the scanner. So you need to
push the ARDF forward fully while trying to detach it in order to detach the tabs.
M160/M161 4-74 SM
ARDF
There are four tabs on the back of the ARDF front cover. Refer to the picture below.
and Adjustment
Replacement
2. ARDF Front Cover [B] ( x1 ,Tab x4)
SM 4-75 M160/M161
ARDF
2. Close the ARDF and then detach the ARDF rear cover [A]. ( x1)
M160/M161 4-76 SM
ARDF
and Adjustment
Replacement
SM 4-77 M160/M161
ARDF
M160/M161 4-78 SM
ARDF
and Adjustment
4.13.8 ARDF DRIVE MOTOR
Replacement
1. ARDF Rear Cover (page 4-76 "ARDF Rear Cover")
2. Original Feed Unit (page 4-78 "Original Feed Unit")
3. Push down the lever [A] to the right.
Push up the lever [A] to the initial position when the replacement is finished.
4. Release the hinges arrowed below to detach the upper guide plate [A].
SM 4-79 M160/M161
ARDF
M160/M161 4-80 SM
ARDF
and Adjustment
Replacement
Do not remove the indicated screw [A].
SM 4-81 M160/M161
ARDF
M160/M161 4-82 SM
ARDF
and Adjustment
Replacement
Push the white plate inward and push the hook down when you try to detach the
white plate. The shepe of the hook is shown below.
SM 4-83 M160/M161
ARDF
4.13.12 DFRB
1. ARDF Rear Cover (page 4-76 "ARDF Rear Cover")
2. DFRB [A] ( x all ,Hook x1)
M160/M161 4-84 SM
ARDF
and Adjustment
Replacement
1. ARDF Rear Cover (page 4-76 "ARDF Rear Cover")
2. ( x1 , x1 , x1 ,Spring x1) shown below
SM 4-85 M160/M161
ARDF
M160/M161 4-86 SM
Scanner
4.14 SCANNER
Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord before you start any of the
procedures in this section.
When you want to detach only the ARDF, see page 4-73 "ARDF Unit".
1. Left Cover (page 4-7 "Left Cover")
2. Right Cover (page 4-8 "Right Cover")
3. Pulling the side of the operation panel lower cover [B], release the hooks of the
and Adjustment
operation panel upper cover [A] and remove the covers. (Hook x4)
Replacement
There are four tabs on the back of the front right cover [A]. Refer to the picture below
before the replacement. Release the tab [B] first when removing the front right cover.
SM 4-87 M160/M161
Scanner
4. Operation Panel Lower Inner Cover (page 4-12 "Operation Panel Lower Inner Cover")
5. Scanner Front Cover [A] (Hook x4)
6. Remove the screws for Scanner Unit and ARDF Unit [A] (Right Side: x3, x1, x4 /
Left Side: x1 / Upper: x1)
Right Side
Left Side
M160/M161 4-88 SM
Scanner
Upper Side
and Adjustment
Replacement
7. Slide the ARDF and the scanner unit [A] to the right and then lift them to detach from
the machine.
SM 4-89 M160/M161
Scanner
M160/M161 4-90 SM
Scanner
4.14.4 CARRIAGE
1. Scanner Upper Cover (page 4-90 "Scanner Upper Cover")
2. Move carriage [A] to the right.
3. Slide the bracket [B] as shown below to detach the belt [A] from the pulley.
and Adjustment
Replacement
4. Bracket [C] ( x3)
In the area [C], the flat cable [B] is fixed with double-sided tape. Do not try to strip the
flat cable [B] off by force.
6. Remove the shaft [B] from the carriage [A].
SM 4-91 M160/M161
Scanner
M160/M161 4-92 SM
Scanner
and Adjustment
Replacement
SM 4-93 M160/M161
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
Service Program Mode
5. SYSTEM MAINTENANCE
Make sure that the data-in LED is not on before you go into the SP mode. This LED
indicates that some data is coming to the machine. When the LED is on, wait for the
printer to process the data.
Do not let the user access the SP mode. Only service representatives are allowed to
access the SP mode. The machine quality or its operation is NOT guaranteed if persons
other than service representatives accesses the SP mode.
5.1.1 SP TABLES
See "Appendices" for the following information:
Service SP Tables
Engine SP Tables-1
Maintenance
Engine SP Tables-2
System
Engine SP Tables-3
Engine SP Tables-4
Engine SP Tables-5
Engine SP Tables-6
Engine SP Tables-7
Engine SP Tables-8
Entering SP Mode
For details, ask your supervisor.
Exiting SP Mode
Press "Exit" on the LCD twice to return to the user screen.
To make the settings effective, turn the main power switch off and on after exiting service
mode.
SM 5-1 M160/M161
Service Program Mode
Type Description
Select one of the Service Program modes (System, Printer, Scanner, or Fax) from the touch panel
as shown in the diagram below after you access the SP mode. This section explains the functions
of the System/Printer/Scanner SP modes. Refer to the Fax service manual for the Fax SP modes.
M160/M161 5-2 SM
Service Program Mode
Press two times to leave the SP mode and return to the user screen to resume
1
normal operation.
Press to scroll to the previous or next display in segments the size of the screen
4
display (page).
5 Press to scroll the show the previous or next line (line by line).
6 Press to move the highlight on the left to the previous or next selection in the list.
Maintenance
1. If you cannot go into the SP mode, ask the Administrator to log in with the User Tool
System
and then set "Service Mode Lock" to OFF after he or she logs in:
User Tools > System Settings > Administrator Tools > Service Mode Lock > OFF
This unlocks the machine and lets you get access to all the SP codes.
The CE can service the machine and turn the machine off and on. It is not necessary to
ask the Administrator to log in again each time the machine is turned on.
2. Go into the SP mode and set SP5169 to "1" if you must use the printer bit switches.
3. After machine servicing is completed:
Change SP5169 from "1" to "0".
Turn the machine off and on. Tell the administrator that you have completed servicing the
machine.
The Administrator will then set the "Service Mode Lock" to ON.
SM 5-3 M160/M161
Updating the Firmware
5.2.1 OVERVIEW
To update the firmware for this machine, you must have the new version of the firmware
downloaded onto an SD (Secure Digital) Card. The SD Card is inserted into SD Card Slot 2
(lower) on the left rear side of the controller box.
Type of
Function Location of firmware Message shown
firmware
Security & HDD encryption / Data Flash ROM on the HDD Format
Encryption Overwrite controller board Option
Page description
Language Flash ROM on the
RPCS RPCS
(RPCS for XPS driver controller board
data process)
Page description
PS3/PDF Flash ROM on the
language PS/PDF
Adobe controller board
(PostScript3)
M160/M161 5-4 SM
Updating the Firmware
Type of
Function Location of firmware Message shown
firmware
Page description
Flash ROM on the
PCL/ PCLXL language PCL/PCL XL
controller board
(PCL)
Maintenance
Application controller board
System
Fax Feature application Flash ROM on the Fax
Application controller board
SM 5-5 M160/M161
Updating the Firmware
Preparation
If the SD card is blank, copy the entire "romdata" folder onto the SD card.
If the card already contains the "romdata" folder, copy the "M160" folder onto the card.
If the card already contains folders up to "M160", copy the necessary firmware files (e.g.
M160xxxx.fwu) into this folder.
Do not put multiple machine firmware programs on the same SD card. Copy the only
model firmware you want.
M160/M161 5-6 SM
Updating the Firmware
Updating Procedure
1. Turn the main power switch off.
2. Remove the slot cover [A] ( × 1).
3. Insert the SD card into SD Card Slot 2 [B].
Make sure the label on the SD card faces the front side of the machine.
Slowly push the SD card into the slot so it locks in place. You will hear it click. Make
Maintenance
System
sure the SD card locks in place.
To remove the SD, push it in to unlock the spring lock. Then release it so it pops out
of the slot.
4. Disconnect the network cable if the machine is connected to a network.
5. Turn the main power switch on.
After a few seconds, the initial version update screen appears on the LCD in English.
6. If the SD card contains more than one software application, the screen will be almost
the same as the one below. The screen below shows that the SC card contains two
applications: "Engine" and "Printer".
7. To select the item for upgrade, touch the selection on the touch panel, or push the
corresponding key on the 10-key pad (1 to 5) of the operation panel. The number in
parentheses tells you which key to push. When you make a selection, the [Verify(./*)]
and [Update(#)] buttons come on the screen.
SM 5-7 M160/M161
Updating the Firmware
What it means
Controller, engine and operation panel firmware cannot be updated at the same time.
It is recommended to update firmware modules one by one.
8. With the selected items shown in reverse color, push the [Update] button or the [#] key
on the operation panel to start the update.
After you push [Update], following screen appears.
M160/M161 5-8 SM
Updating the Firmware
Maintenance
System
10. Turn the main power off and on. Then, select the items that you updated, and then
push the [Verify] button.
This is to check that the modules were updated correctly. Press in the SD card to release it.
Then remove it from the slot.
11. If you see "Verify Error" in the first bar on the screen, then you must do the procedure
again for the module shown in the bottom bar.
SM 5-9 M160/M161
Updating the Firmware
M160/M161 5-10 SM
Updating the Firmware
Maintenance
Cannot be downloaded to a machine with no HDD.
System
32 Different SD card Setting the SD card was interrupted. Cycle the
between download machine off/on.
interruption and If the update cannot be made even if you insert the
download resumption correct SD card, there is a possibility that the SD
card is broken. Retry again with a different SD card.
If you cannot resolve the problem with the above
steps, replace the controller board.
If the program is in the SD card, reinsert the SD
card.
If you updated engine, FCU, or operating unit,
replace each board.
33 Incorrect version data Acquire correct update data then install again.
in the SD card
SM 5-11 M160/M161
Updating the Firmware
M160/M161 5-12 SM
Updating the Firmware
Maintenance
System
SM 5-13 M160/M161
Uploading/Downloading NVRAM Data
All data that is stored in NV-RAM of the engine and controller is subject to update.
This data should always be uploaded to an SD card before the NVRAM is replaced.
Make sure that the write protection of an SD card is unlocked
1. Do SP5990 (SMC Print) before you switch the machine off. You will need a record of the
NVRAM settings if the upload fails.
2. Turn the machine main power switch off.
3. Remove the SD slot cover [A] ( x 1)
4. Insert the SD card into SD card slot [B].
You can upload NVRAM data from more than one machine to the same SD card.
M160/M161 5-14 SM
Uploading/Downloading NVRAM Data
The NVRAM data download may fail if the SD card with the NVRAM data is damaged, or
if the connection between the controller and BICU is defective.
Do the download procedure again if the download fails.
Do the following procedure if the second attempt fails:
Enter the NVRAM data manually using the SMC print you created before uploading the
NVRAM data.
1. Turn the machine main power switch off.
2. Remove the SD slot cover [A] ( x 1)
3. Insert the SD card with the NVRAM data into SD Card Slot [B].
Maintenance
System
4. Turn the machine main power switch on.
5. Do SP5-825-001 (NVRAM Data Download) and press the “Execute” key.
The serial number of the file on the SD card must match the serial number of the machine
for the NVRAM data to download successfully. The download fails if the serial numbers
do not match.
The following data cannot be downloaded to the NVRAM:
Total Count
Total: Full Color
B&W/Single Color
Charging Counters
Copier function option settings specified by the customer support system
SM 5-15 M160/M161
Address Book Upload/Download
Information
Registration No.
Select Title
User Code
Folder
E-mail
Local Authentication
Protection Code
Folder Authentication
Fax Destination
Account ACL
Fax Option
New Document Initial ACL
Group Name
LDAP Authentication
Key Display
If the capacity of SD card is not enough to store the local user information, an error
message is displayed.
Carefully handle the SD card, which contains user information. Do not take it back to your
location.
Maintenance
System
3. Turn on the main power switch.
4. Enter the SP mode, and then execute SP5-846-052 (Restore All Addr Book).
5. Exit from the SP mode, and then turn off the main power switch.
6. Remove the SD card form the SD card slot 2.
7. Install the SD card slot cover.
8. Turn on the main power, and then check that the address book has been restored.
SM 5-17 M160/M161
Capturing Log to SD card
5.5.1 OVERVIEW
In older models, a technician enabled the logging tool after a problem occurred. After that,
when the problem had been reproduced, the technician was able to retrieve the debug
log.
However, this new feature saves the debug logs at the time that problems occur. Then
you can copy the logs to an SD card.
You can retrieve the debug logs using an SD card without a network.
Analysis of the debug log is effective for problems caused by the software. Analysis of the
debug log is not valid for the selection of defective parts or problems caused by
hardware.
Types of debug logs that can be saved
Controller
HDD (4 GB)
debug log
Saved at all times Compressed when written to an SD card
(GW debug
from the HDD (from 4 GB to about 300 MB)
log)
M160/M161 5-18 SM
Capturing Log to SD card
When an engine SC
occurs
When paper
feeding/output stop by
Engine
jams HDD (Up to 300 times)
debug log
When the machine
doors are opened
during normal
operation
When a controller SC
occurs
When saving by
manual operation with
the Number keys and
Operation the Reset key (Press Operation panel (400 MB /Up to 30 times)
Maintenance
panel debug “Reset”, “0”, "1” and When updating the firmware for the operation
System
log “C”(hold for 3 panel, the debug logs are erased.
seconds))
When the operation
unit detects an error
When the operation
panel detects an error
SM 5-19 M160/M161
Capturing Log to SD card
Retrieve debug logs to identify the date of occurrence of the problems and to find details
of the problems
e.g.: At around 8:00 am on March 10, an engine stall occurred. The operation panel does
not respond. Turn the main power supply off / on.
You need to retrieve the debug logs dating back three days from the date of the problem.
Analysis of the debug log is effective for problems caused by the software. Analysis of the
debug log is not valid for the selection of defective parts or problems caused by
hardware.
M160/M161 5-20 SM
Capturing Log to SD card
The approximate time it takes to transfer the debug log is as follows. Transfer time
may be affected by the type or format of the SD card. (It is recommended that you
format the SD card using the Panasonic SD Formatter (freeware)).
Controller debug log (GW debug log): 2 - 20 minutes
Engine debug log: 2 minutes
Operation panel debug log: 2 - 20 minutes
7. Make sure that the SD card access LED is off, then remove the SD card.
If ‘failed’ appears on the touch panel display, turn the power off, and then recover from
step 1 again.
The debug logs are saved with the following file names.
/LogTrace/machine
Controller debug log (GW
number/watching/yyyymmdd_hhmmss_unique
debug log)
identification number.gz
/LogTrace/machine
Maintenance
Engine debug log
number/engine/yyyymmdd_hhmmss.gz
System
/LogTrace/machine
Operation panel debug log
number/opepanel/yyyymmdd_hhmmss.tar.gz
SM 5-21 M160/M161
TROUBLESHOOTING
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
Self-Diagnostic Mode
6. TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshooting
SM 6-1 M160/M161
Service Call
6.2.1 SUMMARY
SCs that disable only the features that use the Turn the main power switch
defective item. Although these SCs are not off and on.
B shown to the user under normal conditions, they
are displayed on the operation panel only when
the defective feature is selected.
Turning the main power switch off then on resets Turn the main power switch
D SCs displayed on the operation panel. These are off and on.
re-displayed if the error occurs again.
M160/M161 6-2 SM
Service Call
Do not try to use the operation panel during an automatic reboot. If the Remote Service
System is in use, the SC code is sent immediately to the Service Center.
The scanner has scanned the white plate, but cannot detect the
certain white level.
Troubleshooting
SC101 D Defective exposure lamp stabilizer
Defective power source harness
Defective signal harness
High-voltage cable leak
Defective darkness starting characteristic
The scanner home position sensor does not detect the scanner
leaving the home position.
SC120 D
Defective scanner home position sensor
Defective scanner home position sensor harness
Defective scanner motor driver
Defective scanner motor
SM 6-3 M160/M161
Service Call
The scanner home position sensor does not detect the scanner
coming back to the home position.
M160/M161 6-4 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
BICU).
SM 6-5 M160/M161
Service Call
SC165 D evergy saver mode, it detects that the installed optional ICIB
is faulty.
M160/M161 6-6 SM
Service Call
GPIO*2 has not been asserted, although the specified time (200
ms) elapsed after setting JOB to be started and reaching the
SC230-00 D FGAT assert time.
Control Board
(*1)FGATE: Signals used between the controller and the engine in order to send the information
about the sub scan length of the page to be printed.
(*2)GPIO: A type of input/output terminal
Troubleshooting
GPIO*2 has not been negated, although the specified time (200
ms) elapsed after detecting GPIO*assert and then reaching the
expected FGATE negate time.
SC231-00 D
* This is an I/O pin. Such I/O pins can be used for a variety of
applications, depending on the setting.
Control Board
Engine Board
(*1)FGATE: Signals used between the controller and the engine in order to send the information
about the sub scan length of the page to be printed.
(*2)GPIO: A type of input/output terminal
SM 6-7 M160/M161
Service Call
When the Engine Board could not read the Unique ID of the
Writing ASIC properly when starting this machine.
When an Error bit occurred in the communication between
SC270-00 D the Engine Board and the Writing ASIC.
(277-00)
M160/M161 6-8 SM
Service Call
Under the condition that the Toner Cartridge has not reached the
end, an error that no toner is supplied has been detected over n
Troubleshooting
times in succession.
n: The value was specified at SP2-931-005.
SM 6-9 M160/M161
Service Call
Under the condition that the toner cartridge has not reached the
end, an error that no toner is supplied has been detected over n
times in succession. (where n is to be configured using
SP2-931-003)
M160/M161 6-10 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
Unmounted sensor (Disconnected connector or broken
SC498-00 C wire)
Failed sensor
SM 6-11 M160/M161
Service Call
The signal from the by-pass bottom plate position sensor has
not changed (the signal has not changed from ON to OFF or
vice versa) for 4 seconds or more after the start of reverse Paper
Feed Unit rotation,
If the error is detected three times in succession, the SC number
is displayed on the operation panel.
When the main motor is driven, the lock (state of rotation) signal
is checked every 100 milliseconds. If the machine detects the
lock signal in the High status 20 times in succession, it reports
SC520-00 D this error.
The main motor incurs too much load from a defective unit.
The main motor is defective.
M160/M161 6-12 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
SC531-00 D Failed fan motor
Disconnected connector
SM 6-13 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-14 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
Clear the SP: fusing SC.
Replace the PSU.
Replace the Engine Board.
SM 6-15 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-16 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
Replace the harness.
Replace the Engine Board.
Replace the PSU.
Replace the fuse.
SM 6-17 M160/M161
Service Call
(553-01)
In a condition of 235 degrees C or higher temperature, the
temperature has increased more than 10 degrees C per 1
second, the heater has continuously reached 100% (maximum)
duty, and the center thermistor has detected the failure to reach
the target temperature by 11 degrees C.
SC553-01 (553-02)
A
SC553-02 The temperature is detected to stay at 245 deg C or higher for
one second.
Shorted triac
Failed Engine Board
M160/M161 6-18 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
Zero-crossing frequency exceeded
None
SM 6-19 M160/M161
Service Call
SC633-00 B Serial line between the optional counter device, the relay board
and copier control board is disconnected or damaged.
M160/M161 6-20 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-21 M160/M161
Service Call
SC636-02 D correct.
M160/M161 6-22 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
Turn the main power off/on.
SM 6-23 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-24 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
If the problem is not solved, replace the modem.
SM 6-25 M160/M161
Service Call
Software bug
Logging only.
SC651-02 C Center.
Software bug
Logging only.
M160/M161 6-26 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
Incorrect remote service ID2
SM 6-27 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-28 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
SC670-00 D Engine start up error
Case 1
/ENGRDY signal was not asserted when the machine
was turned on or returned from energy saver mode.
/IPURDY signal was not asserted when the machine
was turned on or returned from energy saver mode.
The EC response from the engine was not received
within the specified time after turning on the power.
The PC response from the engine was not received
within the specified time after turning on the power.
The SC response from the engine was not received
within the specified time after turning on the power
(MFP models only).
Writing to Rapi driver failed (the other party not found
through PCI).
Case 2
Unexpected down status was detected after /ENGRDY
assertion.
SM 6-29 M160/M161
Service Call
Case 1
Engine board does not start up.
Case 2
Engine board reset unexpectedly.
Controller stalled
Board installed incorrectly
M160/M161 6-30 SM
Service Call
Controller stalled
Board installed incorrectly
SC672-11 D Controller board defective
Operation panel connector is loose, broken, or defective
Controller's late response
Troubleshooting
Communication with controller was interrupted after a normal
startup.
Controller stalled
Board installed incorrectly
SM 6-31 M160/M161
Service Call
Controller stalled
Board installed incorrectly
Controller board defective
SC672-13 D Operation panel connector is loose, broken, or defective
Controller's late response
Controller stalled
Board installed incorrectly
Controller board defective
SC672-99 D Operation panel connector is loose, broken, or defective
Controller's late response
M160/M161 6-32 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
An error is notified during the ID identification after three retries.
SM 6-33 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-34 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
SC816-01 D Subsystem error
SM 6-35 M160/M161
Service Call
SC816-36
D Subsystem error
to94
M160/M161 6-36 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
System program defective
Controller board defective
Optional board defective
HAIC-P2 error
HDD defective
[0x6261]
6261 6420 6469 7200 00 "bad dir"
VM is full
[0x766d]
0x5f706167 "vm_pageout: VM is full”
SM 6-37 M160/M161
Service Call
Others
----
Error in the OS
Others
CPU error
During the self-diagnosis, the controller CPU detects an error.
There are 47 types of error code (0001 to 4005) depending on
the cause of the error. The CPU detects an error and displays
the specific error code with the program address where the error
occurs.
CPU/Memory Error
M160/M161 6-38 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
Defective North Bridge and PCII/F
The CPU detects the video bridge device, but detects error data
SM 6-39 M160/M161
Service Call
HDD timeout
M160/M161 6-40 SM
Service Call
The result of the MAC address check sum does not match the
check sum stored in ROM.
[6101]
Defective SEEP ROM
Defective I2C bus (connection)
PHY IC error
Troubleshooting
An error occurred during the loop-back test for the PHY IC on
the controller.
SM 6-41 M160/M161
Service Call
Verification error
M160/M161 6-42 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
[0401] Defective SDRAM DIMM
Defective controller
The memory structure data error for the optional RAM (SDRAM
DIMM) is detected during self-diagnosis.
[0302]
[0402] Defective RAM DIMM
Defective SPD ROM on RAM DIMM
Defective 12C bus
SM 6-43 M160/M161
Service Call
A verify error occurred when setting data was read from the
clock generator via the I2C bus.
M160/M161 6-44 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
Error in data read from the EEPROM
SM 6-45 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-46 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
Replace wireless LAN board
SM 6-47 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-48 SM
Service Call
NVRAM is defective
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-49 M160/M161
Service Call
None
The display after the restarting instructs the user to format the
HDD.
M160/M161 6-50 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
SM 6-51 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-52 SM
Service Call
SC863-01 D etc.).
Startup takes a long time when the main power is
turned on.
2. It takes a long time after main power on for the operation
panel to become ready.
HDD access may be consuming time. Normal HDD access
time after main power on is about 5 seconds. If the machine
is not waiting for the engine to be ready and it still takes 20
Troubleshooting
to 30 seconds or more, the HDD may be the cause. If there
is a problem with the HDD, HDD-related SCs such as
SC860 and SC863 will occur frequently. Print the SC log
data and check them.
SM 6-53 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-54 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
is a problem with the HDD, HDD-related SCs such as
SC860 and SC863 will occur frequently. Print the SC log
data and check them.
SM 6-55 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-56 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
is a problem with the HDD, HDD-related SCs such as
SC860 and SC863 will occur frequently. Print the SC log
data and check them.
SM 6-57 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-58 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
is a problem with the HDD, HDD-related SCs such as
SC860 and SC863 will occur frequently. Print the SC log
data and check them.
SM 6-59 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-60 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
is a problem with the HDD, HDD-related SCs such as
SC860 and SC863 will occur frequently. Print the SC log
data and check them.
SM 6-61 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-62 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
is a problem with the HDD, HDD-related SCs such as
SC860 and SC863 will occur frequently. Print the SC log
data and check them.
SM 6-63 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-64 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
is a problem with the HDD, HDD-related SCs such as
SC860 and SC863 will occur frequently. Print the SC log
data and check them.
SM 6-65 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-66 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
is a problem with the HDD, HDD-related SCs such as
SC860 and SC863 will occur frequently. Print the SC log
data and check them.
SM 6-67 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-68 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
is a problem with the HDD, HDD-related SCs such as
SC860 and SC863 will occur frequently. Print the SC log
data and check them.
SM 6-69 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-70 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
is a problem with the HDD, HDD-related SCs such as
SC860 and SC863 will occur frequently. Print the SC log
data and check them.
SM 6-71 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-72 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
is a problem with the HDD, HDD-related SCs such as
SC860 and SC863 will occur frequently. Print the SC log
data and check them.
SM 6-73 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-74 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
is a problem with the HDD, HDD-related SCs such as
SC860 and SC863 will occur frequently. Print the SC log
data and check them.
While reading data from the HDD or storing data in the HDD,
data transmission fails.
SC864-00 D
Defective HDD
SM 6-75 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-76 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-77 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-78 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-79 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-80 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-81 M160/M161
Service Call
M160/M161 6-82 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SC865-00 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
SM 6-83 M160/M161
Service Call
The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
SC865-01 D sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in an area that does not belong to a partition,
such as the disklabel area.)
SC865-02 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "a".)
SC865-03 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "b".)
M160/M161 6-84 SM
Service Call
SC865-04 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "c".)
SC865-05 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "d".)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SC865-06 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "e".)
SM 6-85 M160/M161
Service Call
SC865-07 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "f".)
SC865-08 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "g".)
SC865-09 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "h".)
M160/M161 6-86 SM
Service Call
SC865-10 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "i".)
SC865-11 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "j".)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SC865-12 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "k".)
SM 6-87 M160/M161
Service Call
SC865-13 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "l".)
SC865-14 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "m".)
SC865-15 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "n".)
M160/M161 6-88 SM
Service Call
SC865-16 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "o".)
SC865-17 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "p".)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SC865-18 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "q".)
SM 6-89 M160/M161
Service Call
SC865-19 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "r".)
SC865-20 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "s".)
SC865-21 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "t".)
M160/M161 6-90 SM
Service Call
SC865-22 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "u".)
SC865-23 D The HDD returned an error that does not constitute SC863 (bad
sector) or SC864 (CRC error).
(An error occurred in partition "v".)
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-91 M160/M161
Service Call
SD card is defective
* Do not format the SD card supplied with the main machine or sold as an option. You may only format
SD cards used for Firmware Update by the Customer Engineer.
M160/M161 6-92 SM
Service Call
SD card is defective
SD controller is defective
Troubleshooting
main power on.
If an error occurs, use another SD card.
If the error persists even after replacing the SD card,
replace the controller board.
* Do not format the SD card supplied with the main machine or sold as an option. You may only format
SD cards used for Firmware Update by the Customer Engineer.
Address Book data error (On startup: Media required for storing
SC870-01 B
the Address Book is missing.)
SM 6-93 M160/M161
Service Call
SC870-20 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to initialize file.)
SC870-21 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to generate file.)
SC870-22 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to open file.)
SC870-23 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to write to file.)
SC870-24 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to read file.)
SC870-25 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to check file size.)
SC870-26 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to delete data.)
SC870-27 B Address Book data error (File I/O: Failed to add data.)
M160/M161 6-94 SM
Service Call
Troubleshooting
Address Book data error (Encryption settings: Failed to convert
SC870-53 B
from encrypted text to plaintext.)
SM 6-95 M160/M161
Service Call
Address Book data error (Unable to obtain the on/off setting for
SC870-60 B
administrator authentication (06A and later).)
Software bug
Inconsistency of Address Book source location
(machine/delivery server/LDAP server)
Inconsistency of Address Book encryption setting or
encryption key (NVRAM or HDD was replaced individually
without formatting the Address Book)
Address Book storage device (SD/HDD) was temporarily
removed or hardware configuration does not match the
application configuration.
Address Book data corruption was detected.
Defective HDD
SC872-00 B Power failure while accessing the HDD
M160/M161 6-96 SM
Service Call
Defective HDD
SC873-00 B Power failure while accessing the HDD
875-01
SC875-** D Error occurred at “hddchack –I”.
875-02
Data erase failed.
Troubleshooting
Turn the main power switch off and on.
SM 6-97 M160/M161
Service Call
SC876-04 D Log encryption key is disabled but the log data file is
encrypted.(NVRAM data corruption)
Log encryption key is enabled but the log data file is not
encrypted.(NVRAM data corruption)
M160/M161 6-98 SM
Service Call
Other causes
Troubleshooting
-
SM 6-99 M160/M161
Service Call
TPM error
TCSD error
M160/M161 6-100 SM
Service Call
MLB error
The response is not received within the specified time during the
access to the MLB.
SC880-00 D
Defective MLB
Troubleshooting
SC No. Level Error Name/Error Condition/Major Cause/Solution
SM 6-101 M160/M161
Service Call
920-00
At PM startup, no response was returned within the
specified period of time.
920-01
SC920-** B A time-out occurred during PM operation.
920-02
WORK memory acquisition failed.
920-03
The filter process cannot be started.
920-04
The filter process was aborted.
M160/M161 6-102 SM
Service Call
A font that is usually included as the standard font was not found
SC925-00
B Net File function error
SC925-01
The Net File storage area on the HDD is not available, or the
management file used for handling the Net File data is broken.
As a result, access to the Net File data cannot be continued.
Troubleshooting
SM 6-103 M160/M161
Service Call
Defective HDD
HDD inconsistency caused by switching the machine off
while writing to HDD
Software bug
When HDD error-related service calls (SC860-SC865) are
issued at the same time:
This error can be caused by a defective HDD. Therefore, take
the necessary countermeasures specified for SC860, etc.
When other HDD error-related service calls (SC860-SC865)
are NOT issued at the same time:
1) Turn the main power switch off and on.
2) If it cannot be restored by taking the above measure,
initialize the Net File partition in the HDD.
Note, however, that this may delete stored data such as
documents remaining in the Fax transmission queue and
those waiting for capture. Therefore, you must obtain the
consent of your customer before executing the initialization.
Note that after executing commands including
Plumeria/Palm2, the job history will also be cleared.
3) If the error persists even after taking the above step,
initialize all of the partitions in the HDD in accordance with
SP5-832-001, then turn the main power off and then on
again.
Note, however, that this step will clear all of the data stored
on the HDD including various documents, address book
data, and so on. Therefore, again you must obtain the prior
consent of your customers. Note that saved received Fax
documents will be protected, but the receiving order may not
be maintained.
4) If the error still cannot be restored, replace the HDD.
M160/M161 6-104 SM
Service Call
Incorrect argument
Incorrect internal parameter
Insufficient working memory
Abnormal performance caused by an error that cannot be
detected in normal SC detection due to hardware
specifications.
Troubleshooting
Insufficient working memory
May have resulted from an error that cannot be detected by
the hardware using normal SC detection.
Not required
Undefined SC error
SM 6-105 M160/M161
Service Call
SC994-00 C limit for images managed in the service layer of the firmware.
This can occur if there are too many application screens open
on the operation panel.
Logging only.
Software bug
M160/M161 6-106 SM
Service Call
Software bug
Troubleshooting
SC998-00 D An option required by the application (RAM, DIMM, board) is
not installed properly
SM 6-107 M160/M161
Jam Detection
M160/M161 6-108 SM
Jam Detection
Troubleshooting
8. Paper End Sensor (Optional Bank)
Jam code: Shows the cause of a jam. Appears in the log data.
Position code: Shows the location of a jam. Appears on the operation panel.
These are lists of jam codes for the main machine and peripheral devices. Please note:
Late jam. The paper has failed to arrive within the prescribed time due to a jam that has
occurred upstream of the referenced sensor.
Lag jam. The paper has failed to leave the location of the referenced sensor within the
prescribed time due to a jam downstream of the referenced sensor.
SM 6-109 M160/M161
Jam Detection
ARDF
Jam
Jam Type Position Code
Code
1 Initial jam P
Main Machine
Jam
Jam Type Position Code
Code
B
1 Paper Exit Sensor Jam
Z1
Z1
1 Duplex Entrance Sensor Jam
Z2
B
20 Paper Exit Sensor: Late Jam
C
B
60 Paper Exit Sensor: Lag Jam
Z1
M160/M161 6-110 SM
Jam Detection
Jam
Jam Type Position Code
Code
B
23 Duplex Exit Sensor: Late Jam
C
Z1
66 Duplex Entrance Sensor: Lag Jam
Z2
Optional Bank
Jam
Jam Type Position Code
Code
A1
Troubleshooting
53 Tray 2 Relay Sensor(Vertical Transprot Sensor) : Lag Jam
Y1
A1
54 Tray 3 Relay Sensor(Vertical Transprot Sensor) : Lag Jam Y1
Y2
SM 6-111 M160/M161
Troubleshooting
6.4 TROUBLESHOOTING
Do not operate the machine until the test pattern has been printed. Otherwise, an SC
occurs.
1. Enter the SP mode, and then select SP2-109-001.
2. Select the pattern number, and then press [OK].
3. Display the Copy function by pressing [Start] key, and then specify the scanning
conditions for test pattern print.
4. Press [Start] key to print the test pattern.
5. Check the test pattern, and then go back to SP mode.
M160/M161 6-112 SM
Troubleshooting
Adjust the blank margin width only if it cannot be adjusted by registration (leading
edge/side-to-side). First adjust C and D; then A and B.
Troubleshooting
2. Adjust the blank margin width of the image with SP2-103-(001-004).
Leading edge: 2.7 to 9.9 mm (Default: 3.0 mm)
Trailing edge: 0.0 to 9.9 mm (Default: 2.0 mm)
Left: 0.0 to 9.9 mm (Default: 2.0 mm)
Right: 0.0 to 9.9 mm (Default: 2.0 mm)
SM 6-113 M160/M161
Troubleshooting
Print Area
Check that the adjustment meets the product specification.
Adjustment Procedure
1. Enter the SP mode, and then print the test pattern (17: Trim Area) with SP2-109-001.
Print the test pattern, and then adjust the leading edge registration in the SP mode to
the optimum value.
2. Do SP1-002-(001,002,003,004,006) to check and adjust the registration.
3. Check the side-to-side registration for each paper feed trays.
M160/M161 6-114 SM
Troubleshooting
A: Sub-scan magnification
1. Place the test chart on the exposure glass and make a copy from one of the paper feed
Troubleshooting
trays.
2. Check the magnification ratio. If necessary, adjust the magnification with the following
SP mode.
SM 6-115 M160/M161
Troubleshooting
Registration
M160/M161 6-116 SM
Troubleshooting
Magnification
1. Place the temporary test chart on the ARDF and make a copy from one of the paper
feed trays.
2. Check the magnification and adjust it with SP6-017-001 if necessary.
Troubleshooting
components.
The following diagram shows the possible symptoms (black or white dots at regular intervals or
other problems).
SM 6-117 M160/M161
Troubleshooting
The LED head contains 26 LED chips, each covering a line 8 mm wide. If a line 8 mm wide
extending in the paper feed direction appears, an LED chip may be damaged. If so, replace the
LED head.
If the [Drum Rotation] function is performed many times, the life of the drum unit may be
shortened.
Troubleshooting
The effectiveness of the fusing cleaning varies depending on the types of images printed
or papers used until now. Therefore, the problem may be improved by performing the
[Fusing Roller Cleaning] several times, which consumes the toners.
SM 6-119 M160/M161
Troubleshooting
If the number of stacked sheets is substantial, you can prevent the stack from spilling by adjusting
the stop [A]. The stop supports paper up to Legal size.
M160/M161 6-120 SM
Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting
SM 6-121 M160/M161
ENERGY SAVE
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
Energy Save
7. ENERGY SAVE
The area shaded grey in this diagram represents the amount of energy that is saved when the
timers are at the default settings. If the timers are changed, then the energy saved will be different.
For example, if the timers are all set to 240 min., the grey area will disappear, and no energy is
saved before 240 min. expires.
Energy Save
Sleep Mode Setting
Sleep Mode Entry by Sleep Mode Timer
The user can specify whether or not to use Sleep Mode with User Tools. (System settings >
Administrator Tools > Sleep Mode Entry by Sleep Mode Timer)
Default: [Enable]
Sleep Mode Timer
The user can set these timers with User Tools (System settings > Timer setting > Sleep Mode
Timer)
Default: 1 min. (1- 240 min):
SM 7-1 M160/M161
Energy Save
Weekly Timer
(System settings > Timer Settings > Weekly Timer)
Specify the time when the machine switches to and from Off mode or Sleep mode. This timer can
be set for Monday through Sunday. You can set up to six timer settings a day.
Default: [Inactive]
If you select [Daily] or [Day of the Week], specify [Weekly Timer Code], [Weekly Timer Schedule],
or [Timer Suspension Period].
Weekly Timer Schedule
Weekly Timer 1 to 6
Event
Enter Sleep Mode
Cancel Weekly Timer Code
Power Off
Power On
None
Default for "Event": [None]
If an event is selected, enter the time for the event in "Event Timer".
Timer Suspension Period
Set the dates for [Start Date] and [End Date] using the number keys.
If the Weekly Timer setting is specified, you can set a password (using up to eight digits) for when
the machine recovers from Off mode or Sleep mode. After the password has been registered, the
screen requiring the password is displayed when you press the [Energy Saver] key or [Check
Status] key during Off mode or Sleep mode. The machine will recover from Off mode or Sleep
mode when you press the [Energy Saver] key or [Check Status] key after entering the password. If
you select [Off], you do not have to enter a password to recover the machine from Off mode or
Sleep mode.
If the Timer Suspension Period timer has been set and the machine's main power switch is not
turned on at the date specified for [End Date] in [Timer Suspension Period], the Power On timer
will not be performed although the Timer Suspension Period term expires. To enable Power On
timer, you need to turn the main power switch on manually.
M160/M161 7-2 SM
Energy Save
SM 7-3 M160/M161
Energy Save
Recommendation
We recommend that the default settings should be kept.
If the customer requests that these settings should be changed, please explain that their
energy costs could increase, and that they should consider the effects on the environment of
extra energy use.
If it is necessary to change the settings, please try to make sure that the Sleep Mode timer is
not too long. Try with a shorter setting first, such as 5 min., then go to a longer one (such as
15 min.) if the customer is not satisfied.
If the Sleep Mode timer is all set to the maximum value, the machine will not begin saving
energy until 240 minutes has expired after the last job. This means that after the customer
has finished using the machine for the day, energy will be consumed that could otherwise be
saved.
If you change the settings, the energy consumed can be measured using SP8941, as
explained below.
M160/M161 7-4 SM
Energy Save
Time Power
Differences Consumption
Power SP8941: Start Time: End Time:
Machine (Data:b - (Data:a x
Consumption Machine (min.) (min.)
Date Data: c) Data:d)
(W): Data: a Status Data: b Data: c
(min.) Data: (Wmin.)
d Data: e
001:
Operating NA: 543W NA: 161271
Operating 21089 21386 21386
mode EU: 565W EU: 167805
Time
Ready
002:
mode
51W Standby 306163 308046 308046 96033
(stand
Time
by)
Energy 003:
mode Energy
1W or less 0 0 0 0
(Panel Save
off) Time
005: Off
Sleep
1W or less mode 508776 508776 520377 11601
mode
Time
Energy Save
Total Time of Data: d (min.) 17506
NA: 343405
Total Power Consumption of Data: e (Wmin.)
EU: 349939
NA:5.72342
Total Power Consumption of Data: e /60min./1000W (KWH)
EU: 5.83232
SM 7-5 M160/M161
Paper Save
1. Duplex:
2. Combine mode:
M160/M161 7-6 SM
Paper Save
3. Duplex + Combine:
Using both features together can further reduce paper volume by 1/4!
To check the paper consumption, look at the total counter and the duplex counter.
The total counter counts all pages printed.
For one duplex page, the total counter goes up by 2.
For a duplex job of a three-page original, the total counter goes up by 3.
The duplex counter counts pages that have images on both sides.
For one duplex page, the duplex counter goes up by 1.
For a duplex job of a three-page original, the duplex counter will only increase by 1, even
though two sheets are used.
Recommendation
Please explain the above features to the customers, so that they can reduce their paper usage.
Total counter: SP 8581-001
Duplex counter: SP 8411-001
Single-sided with combine mode: SP 8421-004
Duplex with combine mode: SP 8421-005
Energy Save
The following table shows paper savings and how the counters increase for some simple
examples of single-sided and duplex jobs
SM 7-7 M160/M161
Paper Save
Duplex mode:
1 1 1 0 1 0
2 2 1 1 2 1
3 3 2 1 3 1
4 4 2 2 4 2
5 5 3 2 5 2
10 10 5 5 10 5
20 20 10 10 20 10
If combine mode is used, the total and duplex counters work in the same way as explained
previously. The following table shows paper savings and how the counters increase for some
simple examples of duplex/combine jobs.
2 in 1 mode:
Single-sided with
Simplex Sheet Duplex Paper Total counter
Originals combine mode
used Sheets used Saved SP8581-001
SP8421-004
1 1 1 0 1 1
2 2 1 1 1 1
3 3 2 1 2 2
4 4 2 2 2 2
5 5 3 2 3 2
10 10 5 5 5 5
20 20 10 10 10 10
M160/M161 7-8 SM
Paper Save
Duplex + 2 in 1 mode:
Duplex with
Simplex Sheet Duplex Paper Total counter
Originals combine mode
used Sheets used Saved SP8581-001
SP8421-005
1 1 1 0 1 1
2 2 1 1 1 1
3 3 1 2 2 2
4 4 1 3 2 2
5 5 2 3 3 3
6 6 2 4 3 3
7 7 2 5 4 4
8 8 2 6 4 4
9 9 3 6 5 5
10 10 3 7 5 5
11 11 3 8 6 6
12 12 3 9 6 6
Energy Save
SM 7-9 M160/M161
M160/M161
SERVICE MANUAL APPENDICES
M160/M161 APPENDICES
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM Appendix i M160/M161
General Specifications
M160/M161 ii SM Appendix
APPENDIX:
SPECIFICATIONS
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
General Specifications
1. APPENDICES: SPECIFICATIONS
Specifications
Appendices:
1.1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
1.1.1 MAINFRAME
Items Specification
Type Desktop
Standard: 1GB
Memory
Extension: 1.5GB
Photosensitivity
OPC Drum
Type
Development
Non-magnetic one-component development system
System
Items Specification
ADF Original
50 sheets (Thickneses: 67g/m 2)
Capacity
Items Specification
Specifications
Appendices:
Leading edge: 3.0±1.5mm
Trailing edge: 3.0mm
Missing Image Left edge: 2.0±1.5mm
Area (Copier) Right edge: 2.0mm
The missing image area of envelopes is 15 mm (0.6 inches) for
the leading edge and 10 mm (0.4 inches) for the other edges.
Reproduction
25 - 400% (by 1% step)
Ratio (Zoom)
Paper Feed
Max. 1600 sheets
Capacity
Standard: 500 sheets (Main) + 100 sheets (Bypass tray)
(80g/m 2,
Option: 500 sheet tray x 2
20lb.Bond)
1.1.2 PRINTER
Items Specification
Resolution 300/600/1200dpi
Standard:
RPCS, PCL5e/6, Postscript3, PDF Direct
Printer Language
Option:
XPS, IPDS
Standard:
Ethernet(1000BASE-T, 100BASE-TX, 10BASE-T), USB2.0
(Type A), USB2.0 (Type B), SD card
Interface
Option:
IEEE1284, IEEE802.11a/b/g/n (Wireless LAN), NIC (Print
server)
Reproduction
25 - 400%
Ratio
1.1.3 SCANNER
Specifications
Appendices:
Items Specification
Scan Speed Scan to Email / Scan to Folder / WSD scanner / Save to external
media / Network delivery scanner: Original size: A4(SEF), Scanning
one-side)
Black/White:
30 ipm or more (200dpi/300dpi)
Full color:
30 ipm or more (200dpi)
20 ipm or more (300dpi)
Items Specification
Network: TCP/IP
Scan to Email: SMTP
Scan to Folder: SMB, FTP, NCP
Protocol
WSD scanner: Web Service on Devices for Scanning
Network TWAIN scanner: TCP/IP
WIA scanner: TCP/IP
Scan to
Email/Folder TIFF, JPEG, PDF, High Compression PDF, PDF/A
Format
Specifications
Appendices:
1.2.1 PAPER FEED
A3 (SEF) 297×420 N N N N
A3 (LEF) 420×297 N N N N
B4 (SEF) 257×364 N N N N
B4 (LEF) 364×257 N N N N
A4 (SEF) 210×297 A A D C
A4 (LEF) 297×210 N N N N
B5 (SEF) 182×257 B B D C
B5 (LEF) 257×182 N N N N
A5 (SEF) 148×210 A A D C
A5 (LEF) 210×148 B B D C
B6 (SEF) 128×182 B B D C
B6 (LEF) 182×128 N N D N
A6 (SEF) 105×148 A A D C
A6 (LEF) 148×105 N N N N
LG (SEF) 8 1/2"×14" A A D C
LT (SEF) 8 1/2"×11" A A D C
F (SEF) 8"×13" B B D C
F (LEF) 13"×8" N N N N
8K (SEF) 267×390 N N N N
Custom Size
mm 100 – 216 100 – 216 60 – 216 100 – 216
(Width)
Custom Size
mm 148 - 356 210 – 356 127 – 900 148 – 356
(Length)
Double postcard
200×148 B B D N
(SEF)
Double postcard
148×200 B B D N
(LEF)
Specifications
Appendices:
A Supported size. Need to set the dial to the paper size.
Supported size. Need to set the dial “*” and select the paper size by
B
operation panel.
N Not supported.
C Supported.
Supported. Need to select the Bypass Tray and the paper size on operation
D
panel.
N Not supported.
Remarks: Duplex
C Supported.
N Not supported.
Mainframe
A3 (SEF) 297×420 N
A3 (LEF) 420×297 N
B4 (SEF) 257×364 N
B4 (LEF) 364×257 N
A4 (SEF) 210×297 C
A4 (LEF) 297×210 N
B5 (SEF) 182×257 C
B5 (LEF) 257×182 N
A5 (SEF) 148×210 C
A5 (LEF) 210×148 C
B6 (SEF) 128×182 C
B6 (LEF) 182×128 N
A6 (SEF) 105×148 C
A6 (LEF) 148×105 N
LG (SEF) 8 1/2"×14" C
LT (SEF) 8 1/2"×11" C
F (SEF) 8"×13" C
F (LEF) 13"×8" N
Specifications
Appendices:
8K (SEF) 267×390 N
Custom Size
mm 60 – 216
(Width)
Custom Size
mm 127 – 900
(Length)
Double postcard
200×148 C
(SEF)
Double postcard
148×200 C
(LEF)
C Supported.
N Not supported.
10" x 14" - Y - -
Specifications
Appendices:
8K (267 x 390) - - Y*3 y*2
7.25" x 10.5"
- Y - -
(Executive)
10.5" x 7.25"
- y*2 - -
(Executive)
*1: Use SP4-303 to detect original sizes as A5 lengthwise/HLT when the message "Can-t detect
original size" shows.
*2: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP6-016-1. In default
setting, "Y" is detected. "y" can be detected if you change setting of SP6-016-1.
*3: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP4-305-1.
*4: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP5-126-1.
The printer drivers and utility software are provided on one CD-ROM. An auto-run installer lets you
select the components you want to install.
Printer
Windows XP Windows Vista Windows 7 Windows 8
Language
Windows
Printer Windows Windows Mac OSX
Server 2008 /
Language Server 2003 Server 2012 10.5 or later
2008 R2
Specifications
Appendices:
Printer
Windows XP Windows Vista Windows 7 Windows 8
Language
Windows
Printer Windows Windows Mac OSX
Server 2008 /
Language Server 2003 Server 2012 10.5 or later
2008 R2
The Network TWAIN and LAN Fax drivers are provided on the scanner drivers CD-ROM.
This software lets you fax documents directly form your PC. Address Book Editor and
Cover Sheet Editor are to be installed as well. (These require the optional fax unit.)
Software Description
Device Manager NX Lite A PC Client based application program that monitors and
Specifications
Appendices:
1.4.1 PAPER FEED UNIT PB1060
Paper Size A4, B5, A5, B6, A6, Legal, Letter, HLT, Executive,
F, Foolscap, Folio, 16K, Custom size: Min.
100mm x 216mm (3.93" x 8.46"), Max. 216mm x
356mm (8.46" x 14.0")
14-43 lbs
Dimension (W x D x H) W370×D392×H95 mm
W14.6×D15.4×H3.7 inch
Weight 4.1 kg
9.0 lbs.
Paper Size A4, B5, A5, B6, A6, Legal, Letter, HLT, Executive,
F, Foolscap, Folio, 16K, Custom size: Min.
100mm x 216mm (3.93" x 8.46"), Max. 216mm x
356mm (8.46" x 14.0")
14-43 lbs
Dimension (W x D x H) W370×D392×H125 mm
W14.6×D15.4×H4.9 inch
Weight 4.5 kg
9.9 lbs.
TABLES
Maintenance
Appendices:
Preventive
Tables
2.1.1 MAINTENANCE TABLES FOR USER MAINTENANCE MODEL
(M160)
Chart: A4 (LT)/5%
Mode: 3 prints/job
Ratio: 50%
Environment: Normal temperature and humidity
Yield may change depending on circumstances and print conditions.
Symbol keys: C: Clean, R: Replace
Mainframe
Paper Feed
PCDU
PCDU R
LED Optics
Transfer/Fusing
Transport Roller R
Replace to the maintenance kit
Fusing Unit R
Maintenance
Appendices:
Preventive
Environment: Normal temperature and humidity
Tables
Yield may change depending on circumstances and print conditions.
Symbol keys: C: Clean, R: Replace
Mainframe
Paper Feed
Registration
C Remove paper dusts
Sensor
PCDU
PCDU R
LED Optics
Transfer/Fusing
Transfer Roller R
Fusing Unit R
Image Transfer
Entrance Guide C *1
(front)
Image Transfer
Exit Guide C *1
(Rear)
Paper Exit
Maintenance
Appendices:
Preventive
Tables
Paper Exit
C Remove paper dusts
Sensor
Scanner
ARDF
Clean toner and paper dust with a slightly wet cloth. Wipe off towards to the center from the
green seals indicated at both sides. Make sure you do not use alcohol or detergent but water,
and also do not wipe off to the outside.
2. Image Transfer Exit Guide (Rear)
Maintenance
Appendices:
Preventive
Tables
Clean toner stacked in the hollows with a slightly wet cloth. Wipe off five to six times towards
to the center from outside until stacked toner is completely wiped off.
Make sure you do not use detergent and also do not wipe off to the outside.
2.1.3 OTHER
Service
User Maintenance
Yield (Page) Condition Maintenance Model
Model (M160)
(M161)
As for Service Maintenance Model (M161), service technicians must replace all the consumables
other than toners.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
Example: [-9 to +9 / 0 / 0.1 mm step]. The setting
can be adjusted in the range ±9, value reset to
[range / default / step]
+3.0 after an NVRAM reset, and the value can be
changed in 0.1 mm steps with each key press.
1-001-001 By-pass E*
1-001-002 Tray 1 E*
1-001-004 Tray 3 E*
1-001-006 Duplex E*
1-002-001 By-pass E*
1-002-002 Tray 1 E*
1-002-004 Tray 3 E*
1-002-006 Duplex E*
[Paper Buckle]
This SP eliminates the amount of buckle at the registration roller.
When paper is fed from the paper cassette, before the registration
rollers start to rotate the leading edge of the paper stops and hits the
nip of the registration rollers and stops.
The registration rollers remain idle long enough to stop the paper from
1003
skewing in the paper path.
This SP adjusts the amount of time that the registration rollers remain
idle to reduce paper buckle.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
Raise this setting to lengthen the amount of time that the paper pauses
at the nip of the registration rollers if you notice a large amount of skew
in printouts.
[Flicker Control]
1101
Sets the flicker control (0: Disable, 1: Enable).
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
1-101-001 Flicker Control E* 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
[PrintTargetTemp]
1105 Adjusts the target fusing temperature for each paper type. "C" indicates the
center of the roller.
1105 [CurlDecMode]
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
1-105-021 Mode Display E* Enables or disables the CurlDecMode
(0: Disabled, 1: Enabled)
[PrintTargetTemp]
1105 Specifies the heating roller target temperature for coated paper (Center)
during printing.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
SP Mode Tables
1-105-031 FuserOffMode E* The switch that turns the fuser off after
Appendices:
the idle process runs over 30 minutes.
[FusingTempDisp]
1106
This SP displays the hot roller and pressure roller temperatures.
[Inrush Control]
1135
Enables or disables the setting of Inrush control (0: Disabled, 1: Enabled)
[NipWidthMeasuring]
1152
Checks the fusing nip band.
[FusingJamDetect]
Disables or enables the consecutive jam error for the fusing unit.
1159
When set to "1" (on) this SC code is issued after the 3rd consecutive jam in
the fusing unit.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
1-152-001 SCdisplay E* 0: Not detects SC
1: Detects SC
[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1mm/step]
Adjusts the reverse stop timing of the
range from the Registration Sensor
1-907-005 Reverse Stop Posi E*
OFF to the Paper Exit Inverter motor.
Makes it slower (+) or faster (-) than the
default.
[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1mm/step]
Adjusts the reverse stop timing of the
range from the duplex entrance sensor
1-907-015 Re-Feed Stop Posi E*
ON to the duplex clutch.
Makes it slower (+) or faster (-) than the
default.
SP Mode Tables
1908 Adjusts the timing of paper feed. (A "+" setting broadens paper feed
Appendices:
interval, a “-” setting narrows paper feed interval.)
1-922-001 By-pass E*
1-922-002 Tray 1 E*
[-4.0 to 4.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
1-922-003 Tray 2 E*
1-922-004 Tray 3 E*
1-952-001 - E* [0 to 60 / 13 / 1min/step]
1-998-001 reserve01 E*
1-998-002 reserve02 E*
1-998-004 reserve04 E*
1-998-005 reserve05 E*
1-998-006 reserve06 E*
1-998-007 reserve07 E*
1-998-009 reserve09 E*
1-998-010 reserve10 E*
2001 [C biasControl]
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
2-001-001 C setting E
This setting is available when
the bias control is OFF.
[Reg Correct]
2101
The amount of the correction for the main scan position.
[Magnification Adj]
2102
Sub Scan Magnification Adjustment
SP Mode Tables
Adjusts the erase margin by deleting image data at the margins.
Appendices:
2-103-001 Lead Edge Width E [2.7 to 9.9 / 3.0 / 0.1mm/step]
2-103-004 Right E
2103 [Erase Margin Adj] Image Erase Margin Adjustment: Back side
2-103-005 Duplex:Lead E
2-103-006 Duplex:Trail. E
[0.0 to 4.0 / 0.0 / 0.1mm/step]
2-103-007 Duplex:Left Width E
2-103-008 Duplex:RightWidth E
2-106-021 Print:Normal E
2-106-022 Print:Low E
[1000 to 8800 / 3000 / 1ns/step]
2-106-023 Quenching:Normal E
2-106-024 Quenching:Low E
[Test Printing]
2109
Printing test patterns
[0 to 17 / 0 / 1/step]
Pattern
2-109-001 E See the selections below. See also
Selection
page 3-233 for checking the procedure.
SP Mode Tables
2-201-002 DV(+)_offset E* [-100 to 0 / 0 / 25v/step]
Appendices:
2-201-003 DV(-)_offset E* [-75 to 75 / 0 / 25v/step]
[PcuReverse]
2211
Switches the PCU reverse on / off.
[0 to1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: Switch Off
2-211-001 On/Off E*
1: Switch On with the reverse rotation
sheet counts
2212 [ExeSheets]
[1 to 500 / 50 / 1page/step]
Stops printing and executing reversing
2-212-002 LowPrinting E*
PCU every sheets that has been set for
low printing.
[LEDA Data:Display]
2221
Displays LEDA data.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
in each area for the type of paper in use.
[1 to 50 / 14 / 1uA/step]
2-301-001 T(+)_1:setting E* Displays the setting of the transfer bias
control level for non image area.
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1uA/step]
Displays the setting of the offset
2-301-002 T(+)_2_FaceOffset E* amount of transfer bias control level
during creating an image on the face
page.
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1uA/step]
Displays the setting of the offset
2-301-003 T(+)_2_BackOffset E* amount of transfer bias control level
during creating an image on the back
page.
[0 to 100 / 80 / 1%/step]
Output adjustment for the value of the
2-301-101 Used Adjust A2 E* transfer output table which is to be a
basis when the transfer paper count is
in the range of 15K and 30K.
[0 to 100 / 70 / 1%/step]
Output adjustment for the value of the
2-301-102 Used Adjust A3 E* transfer output table which is to be a
basis when the transfer paper count is
in the range of 30K and 60K.
[0 to 100 / 65 / 1%/step]
Output adjustment for the value of the
2-301-103 Used Adjust A4 E* transfer output table which is to be a
basis when the transfer paper count is
in the range of 60K and 90K.
[0 to 100 / 60 / 1%/step]
Output adjustment for the value of the
2-301-104 Used Adjust A5 E* transfer output table which is to be a
basis when the transfer paper count is
over 90K.
2411 [envi_section]
[Supply Speed]
2924
For circulating the time to supply certain amount
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
during printing.
[0 to 300 / 5 / 1g/step]
2-926-001 Recovery Amount E*
Amount for Recovery Supply.
[0 to 300 / 10 / 1sec/step]
2-926-002 Mixing Time E*
Idle time to mix for Recovery Supply.
[0 to 10000 / 0 / 1count/step]
2-926-003 Recovery Count E* Total count of executed Recovery
Supply
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
2-926-004 Self-Recovery E
Forcibly executes one time Recovery
Supply.
[1 to 50 / 5 / 1g/step]
2-927-001 Initial Amount E* Target toner amount for supplying fixed
amount of toner when replacing.
[0 to 300 / 10 / 1sec/step]
2-927-002 Initial Mixing T E* Idle time to mix for supplying fixed
amount of toner when replacing.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
2-927-004 Initial Flag E* Information used to detect the
replacements and judge the upper limit.
[0 to 1000 / 0 / 1count/step]
2-927-005 Exchange Count E*
Counter for new toner detection.
2930 [Detection]
[1 to 20 / 5 / 1cycle/step]
Counter to rotate the cleaner parts
2-930-001 Cleaner Count E*
when remaining toner in the developer
detected.
[0 to 20 / 1 / 1/step]
Upper counter to exclude from the
2-930-003 Upper n cycle E*
obtained result when toner remaining in
the developer detected.
[0 to 20 / 1 / 1/step]
Lower counter to set it aside from the
2-930-004 Lower m cycle E*
obtained result if toner remaining in the
developer detected.
[0 to 70 / 25 / 1count/step]
Counter for judging the upper limit
2-930-005 HH:240 Upper E*
when toner remaining in the developer
detected.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[0 to 70 / 38 / 1count/step]
Counter for judging the lower limit when
2-930-006 HH:240 Lower E*
toner remaining in the developer
detected.
[0 to 70 / 18 / 1count/step]
Counter for judging the upper limit
2-930-007 MM:240 Upper E*
when toner remaining in the developer
detected.
[0 to 70 / 34 / 1count/step]
Counter for judging the lower limit when
2-930-008 MM:240 Lower E*
toner remaining in the developer
detected.
[0 to 70 / 18 / 1count/step]
Counter for judging the upper limit
2-930-009 LL:240 Upper E*
when toner remaining in the developer
detected.
[0 to 70 / 36 / 1count/step]
Counter for judging the lower limit when
2-930-010 LL:240 Lower E*
toner remaining in the developer
detected.
[0 to 70 / 38 / 1count/step]
Counter for judging the upper limit
2-930-011 HH:182 Upper E*
when toner remaining in the developer
detected.
[0 to 70 / 52 / 1count/step]
Counter for judging the lower limit when
2-930-012 HH:182 Lower E*
toner remaining in the developer
detected.
[0 to 70 / 33 / 1count/step]
Counter for judging the upper limit
2-930-013 MM:182 Upper E*
when toner remaining in the developer
detected.
[0 to 70 / 48 / 1count/step]
Counter for judging the lower limit when
2-930-014 MM:182 Lower E*
toner remaining in the developer
detected.
[0 to 70 / 34 / 1count/step]
Counter for judging the upper limit
2-930-015 LL:182 Upper E*
when toner remaining in the developer
detected.
[0 to 70 / 46 / 1count/step]
Counter for judging the lower limit when
2-930-016 LL:182 Lower E*
toner remaining in the developer
detected.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1count/step]
2-930-018 Average Count E* Result of remaining detection in the
developer.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
2-930-019 Self- Detection E
Detects forcibly the toner remaining in
the developer.
[0 to 300 / 10 / 1sec/step]
2-930-020 Self-Mixing Time E* Required time for mixing prior to
forcibly execute remaining detection.
[0 to 10000 / 0 / 1count/step]
2-931-002 0 count E*
Counter for detecting the SC364.
[1 to 50 / 30 / 1count/step]
2-931-003 0 count Threshold E*
Threshold for detecting the SC364.
[0 to 10000 / 0 / 1count/step]
2-931-004 Lower Count E*
Counter for detecting the SC332.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[1 to 10 / 5 / 1count/step]
2-931-005 Lower Threshold E*
Threshold for detecting the SC332.
[0 to 10 / 0 / 1count/step]
2-931-006 SC332 Count E* Counts that continuously detected the
SC332.
[0 to 300 / 0 / 1sec/step]
2-940-002 Remaining Time E*
Threshold for detecting toner end.
[Remain Control]
2941 Counter for supplying triggered by the front cover open/close during Power
ON.
[S_PaperRefresh]
2952 Correction coefficients of the toner refresh control when printing the small
sized paper.
2961 [CleaningOperation]
[0 or 1 / 0 /1 / step]
The trigger of drum cleaning operation
2-961-001 Level 1 E*
level 1.
Select 1 to execute.
[0 or 1 / 0 /1 / step]
The trigger of drum cleaning operation
2-961-002 Level 2 E*
level 2.
Select 1 to execute.
[Duty Control]
2990 Correction values of printing interval control in order to avoid the increasing
temperature from continuous printing.
[1 to 100 / 34 / 1msec/step]
2-998-001 T:ReverseRotation E* Adjusts the reverse rotation time of
PCU reverse rotation.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[1 to 100 / 30 / 1msec/step]
2-998-003 T:NormalRotation E* Adjusts the normal rotation time of PCU
reverse rotation.
[0 to 2 / 1 / 1/step]
0: earlier
3-098-001 Toner E*
1: normal
2: later
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1-/step]
3-501-001 On/Off E* 0: Off
1: On
[C Bias Control]
3502
C bias Control: On/Off designation
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
3-502-001 On/Off E* 0: Off
1: On
[0 to 2 / 1 / 1/step]
0: earlier
3-800-001 Waste Toner E*
1: normal
2: later
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[L-Edge Regist Adjustment]
4010
Adjusts the leading edge registration for scanning.
4012
Do not adjust unless the customer desires a scanner margin
greater than the printer margin.These settings are adjusted to
erase shadows caused by the gap between the original and the
scale of the scanner unit.
[Scan]
4014
Executes the scanner free run with each mode.
HP Detection Enable:
4-014-003 E
FC600dpi [- / - / -]
[Execute]
HP Detection Enable:
4-014-004 E
BW600dpi
HP Detection Enable:
4-014-005 E
FC1200dpi
[DF Scan]
4016
-
[Dust Check]
This function checks the narrow scanning glass of the ADF for dust that can
4020
cause black lines in copies. If dust is detected a system banner message is
displayed, but processing does not stop.
SP Mode Tables
detect dust on the white plate above
Appendices:
the scanning glass, as well as dust on
the glass. Sensitivity of the level of
detection is adjusted with SP4020-2.
4-020-001 DustDetect:On/Off E* [0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Off. No dust warning.
1: On. Dust warning. This warning does
not stop the job.
4-400-008 ADF:Right E*
[0 to 8 / 0 / 1/step]
4-417-001 Test Pattern E
See the selections below
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
0 Scanned image 5 Slant grid pattern C
4-429-001 Copying E*
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
4-450-001 Black Subtraction ON/OFF E Uses or does not use the black
reduction image path.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
4-450-002 SH ON/OFF E Uses or does not use the shading
image path.
[Digital AE]
4460
Adjusts the background level.
[Scan Apli:Txt/Print]
4550
Sets the text/print MTF level of the scanner application.
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1/step]
0: MTF OFF
MTF: 0(Off) 1-15 Sets the MTF level (Modulation
4-550-005 E*
(Weak-Strong) Transfer Function) designed to improve
image contrast. Set higher for stronger
effect, lower for weaker effect.
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1/step]
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7
4-550-006 E* Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear.
(Weak-Strong)
Set higher for smoother images.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots.
Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7
4-550-009 E* Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
(Weak-Strong)
weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1/step]
0: MTF OFF
MTF: 0(Off) 1-15 Sets the MTF level (Modulation
4-551-005 E*
(Weak-Strong) Transfer Function) designed to improve
image contrast. Set higher for stronger
effect, lower for weaker effect.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1/step]
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7
4-551-006 E* Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear.
(Weak-Strong)
Set higher for smoother images.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots.
Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7
4-551-009 E* Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
(Weak-Strong)
weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to15 / 8 / 1/step]
0: MTF OFF
MTF: 0(Off) 1-15 Sets the MTF level (Modulation
4-552-005 E*
(Weak-Strong) Transfer Function) designed to improve
image contrast. Set higher for stronger
effect, lower for weaker effect.
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1/step]
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7
4-552-006 E* Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear.
(Weak-Strong)
Set higher for smoother images.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots.
Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7
4-552-009 E* Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
(Weak-Strong)
weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1/step]
0: MTF OFF
MTF: 0(Off) 1-15 Sets the MTF level (Modulation
4-553-005 E*
(Weak-Strong) Transfer Function) designed to improve
image contrast. Set higher for stronger
effect, lower for weaker effect.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1/step]
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7
4-553-006 E* Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear.
(Weak-Strong)
Set higher for smoother images.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots.
Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7
4-553-009 E* Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
(Weak-Strong)
weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1/step]
0: MTF OFF
MTF: 0(Off) 1-15 Sets the MTF level (Modulation
4-554-005 E*
(Weak-Strong) Transfer Function) designed to improve
image contrast. Set higher for stronger
effect, lower for weaker effect.
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1/step]
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7
4-554-006 E* Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear.
(Weak-Strong)
Set higher for smoother images.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots.
Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7
4-554-009 E* Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
(Weak-Strong)
weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1/step]
0: MTF OFF
MTF: 0(Off) 1-15 Sets the MTF level (Modulation
4-565-005 E*
(Weak-Strong) Transfer Function) designed to improve
image contrast. Set higher for stronger
effect, lower for weaker effect.
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1/step]
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7
4-565-006 E* Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear.
(Weak-Strong)
Set higher for smoother images.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots.
Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7
4-565-009 E* Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
(Weak-Strong)
weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1/step]
0: MTF OFF
MTF: 0(Off) 1-15 Sets the MTF level (Modulation
4-570-005 E*
(Weak-Strong) Transfer Function) designed to improve
image contrast. Set higher for stronger
effect, lower for weaker effect.
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1/step]
SP Mode Tables
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7
Appendices:
4-570-006 E* Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear.
(Weak-Strong)
Set higher for smoother images.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots.
Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7
4-570-009 E* Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
(Weak-Strong)
weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1/step]
0: MTF OFF
MTF: 0(Off) 1-15 Sets the MTF level (Modulation
4-571-005 E*
(Weak-Strong) Transfer Function) designed to improve
image contrast. Set higher for stronger
effect, lower for weaker effect.
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1/step]
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7
4-571-006 E* Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear.
(Weak-Strong)
Set higher for smoother images.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots.
Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7
4-571-009 E* Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
(Weak-Strong)
weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1/step]
0: MTF OFF
MTF: 0(Off) 1-15 Sets the MTF level (Modulation
4-572-005 E*
(Weak-Strong) Transfer Function) designed to improve
image contrast. Set higher for stronger
effect, lower for weaker effect.
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1/step]
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7
4-572-006 E* Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear.
(Weak-Strong)
Set higher for smoother images.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots.
SP Mode Tables
Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7
Appendices:
4-572-009 E* Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
(Weak-Strong)
weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1/step]
Sets the MTF level (Modulation
MTF: 0(Off) 1-15
4-580-005 E* Transfer Function) designed to improve
(Weak-Strong)
image contrast. Set higher for stronger
effect, lower for weaker effect.
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1/step]
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7
4-580-006 E* Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear.
(Weak-Strong)
Set higher for smoother images.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots.
Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7
4-580-009 E* Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
(Weak-Strong)
weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of textures. Set
4-580-010 Texture Erase: 0 E*
higher for stronger effect, lower for
weaker effect.
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1/step]
Sets the MTF level (Modulation
MTF: 0(Off) 1-15
4-581-005 E* Transfer Function) designed to improve
(Weak-Strong)
image contrast. Set higher for stronger
effect, lower for weaker effect.
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1/step]
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7
4-581-006 E* Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear.
(Weak-Strong)
Set higher for smoother images.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots.
Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7
4-581-009 E* Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
(Weak-Strong)
weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1/step]
Sets the MTF level (Modulation
MTF: 0(Off) 1-15
4-582-005 E* Transfer Function) designed to improve
(Weak-Strong)
image contrast. Set higher for stronger
effect, lower for weaker effect.
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1/step]
SP Mode Tables
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7
Appendices:
4-582-006 E* Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear.
(Weak-Strong)
Set higher for smoother images.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots.
Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7
4-582-009 E* Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
(Weak-Strong)
weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of textures. Set
4-582-010 Texture Erase: 0 E*
higher for stronger effect, lower for
weaker effect.
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1/step]
Sets the MTF level (Modulation
MTF: 0(Off) 1-15
4-583-005 E* Transfer Function) designed to improve
(Weak-Strong)
image contrast. Set higher for stronger
effect, lower for weaker effect.
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1/step]
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7
4-583-006 E* Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear.
(Weak-Strong)
Set higher for smoother images.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots.
Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7
4-583-009 E* Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
(Weak-Strong)
weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of textures. Set
4-583-010 Texture Erase: 0 E*
higher for stronger effect, lower for
weaker effect.
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1/step]
Sets the MTF level (Modulation
MTF: 0(Off) 1-15
4-584-005 E* Transfer Function) designed to improve
(Weak-Strong)
image contrast. Set higher for stronger
effect, lower for weaker effect.
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1/step]
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7
4-584-006 E* Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear.
(Weak-Strong)
Set higher for smoother images.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots.
Ind Dot Erase: 0(Off) 1-7
4-584-009 E* Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
(Weak-Strong)
weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1/step]
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
Sets the MTF level (Modulation
MTF: 0(Off) 1-15
4-585-005 E* Transfer Function) designed to improve
(Weak-Strong)
image contrast. Set higher for stronger
effect, lower for weaker effect.
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1/step]
Smoothing: 0(x1) 1-7
4-585-006 E* Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear.
(Weak-Strong)
Set higher for smoother images.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots.
Independent Dot Erase (0)/
4-585-009 E* Set higher for stronger effect, lower for
1-7 (Strong)
weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[AGC Execution]
4603
Executes the AGC and enables the home position detection.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
4-603-001 HP Detection Enable E
Executes the AGC with the scanner
detection.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
4-603-002 HP Detection Disable E
Executes the AGC with the scanner
detection.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: OFF, 1: ON
Opens or closes the FGATE signal.
4-604-001 - E
This SP automatically returns to the
default status (close) after exiting this
SP.
SP Mode Tables
4-609-002 DF Scan E*
Appendices:
(adjustment) for the red signal in DF
Scan.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1digit/step]
Displays the black offset value (rough
4-623-001 Latest: R Color 600 E
adjustment) for the even red signal in
the SBU (color printing speed).
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1digit/step]
Displays the black offset value (rough
4-623-002 Latest: R Color 1200 E
adjustment) for the odd red signal in the
SBU (color printing speed).
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1digit/step]
Displays the black offset value (rough
4-624-001 Latest: G Color 600 E
adjustment) for the even green signal in
the SBU (color printing speed).
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1digit/step]
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
Displays the black offset value (rough
4-624-002 Latest: G Color 1200 E
adjustment) for the odd green signal in
the SBU (color printing speed).
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1digit/step]
Displays the black offset value (rough
4-624-003 Latest: BkE E
adjustment) for the even black signal in
the SBU (color printing speed).
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1digit/step]
Displays the black offset value (rough
4-624-004 Latest: BkO E
adjustment) for the odd black signal in
the SBU (color printing speed).
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1digit/step]
Displays the black offset value (rough
4-625-001 Latest: B Color 600 E
adjustment) for the even blue signal in
the SBU (color printing speed).
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1digit/step]
Displays the black offset value (rough
4-625-002 Latest: B Color 1200 E
adjustment) for the odd blue signal in
the SBU (color printing speed).
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
(SCAT).
4654
Black level is checked when scanner turns on, then adjustment value is
given.
Use for design evaluation, analyzing cause of malfunction (abnormal
images, SC).
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
Last Correct Value: G Color
4-662-001 E*
600
SP Mode Tables
600
Appendices:
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1digit/step]
Factory Setting: B Color
4-675-002 E*
1200
4-691-004 BkO E
SP Mode Tables
[Black Level Peak Read]
Appendices:
Display the peak level of the black level scanning.
4694
If these scanned white levels are out of the correct range, SC142 may be
issued.
4-694-004 BkO E
[Home Position]
4804 Moves the exposure lamp a short distance and immediately returns it to its
home position. Touch [Execute]> "Completed"> [Exit].
[- / - / -]
4-804-001 - E
[Execute]
[Carriage Save]
Moves the exposure lamp a short distance away from the home position
and stops.
Touch [Execute]> "Completed"> [Exit]
4806 Do SP4804 to return the exposure lamp to its home position.
[- / - / -]
4-806-001 - E
[Execute]
4810 [PWM]
4-810-003 Latest: Bk E
SP Mode Tables
4-811-003 Latest: G Color 600 E*
Appendices:
4-811-004 Latest: G Color 1200 E*
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1digit/step]
4-811-005 Latest: BkE E*
[Filter Setting]
4903 This SP outputs the final data read at the end of ACC execution.
A zero is returned if there was an error reading the data.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1/step]
4-903-001 Ind Dot Erase: Text E*
Photo C Patch Level 1 (8-bit)
[- / - / -]
4-918-009 - E
[Change]
[Read/Restore Std]
4954
Reads or restores the standard chart.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
0: weakest skew correction,
9: strongest skew correction
[0 to 6 / 3 / 1/step]
Sets blank paper detection level.
4-996-001 - E*
Increasing the value: more sensitive
detecting.
5-009-201 1-8 C*
5-009-202 9-16 C*
[1 to 255 / 00000000 / 1/step]
5-009-203 17-24 C*
5-009-204 25-32 C*
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-024-001 0:mm 1:inch C* 0: mm (Europe/Asia)
1: inch (USA)
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[Accounting counter]
Selects whether the accounting counter is displayed on the LCD or not.
5045
SP5-801-001/003 will not clear this SP. The value will be under an
exclusive control because the value varies in segments.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step ]
5-045-001 Counter Method C* 0: Set
1: Unset
[TonerRefillDetectionDisplay]
5051
Enables or disables the toner refill detection display.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-051-001 - C* 0: ON
1: OFF
[Display IP Address]
5055
Display or does not display the IP address on the operation panel.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-055-001 - C* 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-071-001 - C* 0: Off
1: On
[0 to 2 / 0/ 1 /step]
0: Auto
1: Display
2: Not display
5-074-050 Show Home Edit Menu C* Sets whether to display the home edit
menu on the system initial setting or
WebImageMonitor.
It depends whether the machine has
the Smart Oeration Panel or not.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Function disable
1: SDK application
5-074-091 Function Setting C*
2: MFP browser application
Selects the application to show up
when pressed the home key.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the display category of the
5-074-093 Application Screen ID C*
application that is specified in the
SP5075-001
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
5-076-001 0:OFF 1:ON C* 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
5-081-001 - C* [-/-/-]
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-083-001 Toner Near End C* 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-112-001 (0:OFF 1:ON) C* 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 to 5 / 0 / 1/step]
0: None
1: Key card (RK 2, 3, 4)
2: Key card (down)
3: PrepaidCard
Default Optional Counter
5-113-001 C* 4: Coin Rack
Type
5: MFKeyCard
11: Exp.KeyCard(Add)
12: Exp.KeyCard(Deduct)
This program specifies the counter
type.
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1/step]
0: None
1: Expansion Device 1
External Optional Counter
5-113-002 C* 2: Expansion Device 2
Type
3: Expansion Device 3
This program specifies the external
counter type.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-114-001 MF Key Card Extension C* 0: Not installed
1: Installed (scanning accounting)
[Disable Copying]
5118
This program disables copying.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-118-001 - C* 0: Not disabled
1: Disabled
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
Sets the mode clear operation in removal of counters to all the accounting
counter devices.
Sets whether to operate the mode clear or not when the accounting
devices released (e.g. no key-card, no remains in a card) before starting a
5120
job or during idle after a job end.
If the accounting devices released during a job, the machine starts
canceling the job and then stops the counter. This SP, thus, is aimed to set
whether to do the mode clear operation if the stopped timing was during job
canceling.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Yes (removed)
5-120-001 0: Yes 1: StandBy 2: No C*
1: Standby (installed but not used)
2: No (not removed)
[Counter Up Timing]
5121 Determines whether the optional key counter counts up at paper feed-in or
at paper exit.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-121-001 0:Feed 1:Exit C* 0: Feed
1: Exit
[APS Mode]
5127 Selects whether the APS function is enabled or disabled with the contact of
a pre-paid card or coin lock.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-127-001 - C* 0: Not disabled
1: Disabled
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-162-001 - C 0: Soft Key Set
1: Hard Key Set
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-167-001 - C 0: Automatic printing
1: No automatic printing
[CE Login]
5169 If you will change the printer bit switches, you must “log in” to service mode
with this SP before you go into the printer SP mode.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-169-001 - C* 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
[Copy Nv Version]
5188
Displays the version number of the NVRAM on the controller board.
5-188-001 - C* [- / - / - ]
[Mode Set]
5191
Shifts to the power save mode or not.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-191-001 Power Str Set C* 0: OFF
1: ON
[Limitless Sw]
5195
Sets limitless paper feed.
5-195-001 - C* [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
[Set Time]
Adjusts the RTC (real time clock) time setting for the local time zone.
Examples: For Japan (+9 GMT), enter 540 (9 hours x 60 min.)
JP: +540 (Tokyo)
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
NA: -300 (New York)
5302
EU: + 60 (Paris)
CH: +480 (Peking)
TW: +480 (Taipei)
AS: +480 (Hong Kong)
KO: +540 (Korea)
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
(Default)
1: NA and EUR
0: ASIA and others
[- / 3200210h / -]
Specifies the start setting for the
summer time mode.
There are 8 digits in this SP. For
months 1 to 9, the "0" cannot be input
in the first digit, so the eight-digit
setting for -2 or -3 becomes a
seven-digit setting.
1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12]
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
3rd digit: The week of the month. [1 to
5]
4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 6 =
Sunday to Saturday]
5-307-003 Rule Set(Start) C*
5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23]
7th digit: The length of the advanced
time. [0 to 9 / 1 hour /step]
8th digit: The length of the advanced
time. [0 to 5 / 10 minutes /step]
The digits are counted from the
left.
Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to
"1".
[- / 11100200h / -]
Specifies the end setting for the
summer time mode.
There are 8 digits in this SP.
1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12]
3rd digit: The week of the month. [0 to
5]
4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 7 =
5-307-004 Rule Set(End) C*
Sunday to Saturday]
5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23]
The 7th and 8 digits must be set to
"00".
The digits are counted from the
left.
Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to
"1".
[Accsss Control]
bit0: SDKJ Authentication
-0: Panel Type
-1: Remote Type
bit1: Using user code setup
-0: OFF, 1: ON
bit2: Using key-counter setup
5402 -0: OFF, 1: ON
bit3: Using external billing device setup
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
-0: OFF, 1: ON
bit4: Using extended external billing device setup
-0: OFF, 1: ON
bit5~6: Not used
bit7: Using extended function J limit users
-0: OFF, 1: ON
[Accsss Control]
5402
Sets limited uses for SDKJ application data.
5-402-141 SDKJ1ProductID C*
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
5-402-155 SDKJ15 ProductID C*
[- / - / -]
5-404-001 - C*
[Execute]
5411 [LDAP-Certification]
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: OFF
5-411-004 Simplified Authentication C* 1: ON
Determines whether easy LDAP
certification is done.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: Password NULL permitted.
5-411-005 Password Null Not Permit C* 1: Password NULL not permitted.
This SP is referenced only when
SP5411-4 is set to "1" (On).
[ - / 00000000 / 0x01/step]
Determines whether LDAP option
5-411-006 Detail Option C*
(anonymous certification) is turned on
or off.
[Krb-Certification]
5412
Sets the level of Kerberos Certification.
[- / 11111111 / 1/step]
0x01:AES256-CTS-HMAC-SHA1-96
0x02:AES128-CTS-HMAC-SHA1-96
5-412-100 Encrypt Mode C* 0x04:DES3-CBC-SHA1
0x08:RC4-HMAC
0x10:DES-CBC-MD5
0xFF(0x1F):ALL
[Lockout Setting]
5413
Sets the lockout setting for local address book.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: OFF
5-413-001 Lockout On/Off C* 1: ON
Switches on/off the lock on the local
address book account.
[1 to 10 / 5 / 1time/step]
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
5-413-002 Lockout Threshold C* Sets a limit on the frequency of lockouts
for account lockouts.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: OFF (lockout not cancelled)
1: ON (system waits, cancels lockout if
5-413-003 Cancellation On/Off C* correct user ID and password are
entered)
Determines whether the system waits
the prescribed.
[1 to 9999 / 60 / 1min./step]
Determines the length of time that the
system waits for correct input of the
5-413-004 Cancelation Time C*
user ID and password after a lockout
has occurred. This setting is used only
if SP5413-3 is set to "1" (on).
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: OFF
1: ON
5-414-001 Mitigation On/Off C*
Switches on/off masking of
continuously used IDs and passwords
that are identical.
[0 to 60 / 15 / 1min./step]
Sets the length of time for excluding
5-414-002 Mitigation Time C*
continuous access for identical user IDs
and passwords.
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 time/step]
Sets the number of attempts to attack
5-415-001 Permissible Number C*
the system with random passwords to
gain illegal access to the system.
[1 to 10 / 5 / 1sec/step]
Sets the time limit to stop a password
5-415-002 Detect Time C*
attack once such an attack has been
detected.
[1 to 10 / 3 / 1 sec/step]
Sets the processing time interval for
5-416-003 Monitor Interval C*
referencing user ID and password
information.
[10 to 30 / 10 / 1sec/step]
Sets the length of time for monitoring
5-417-002 Attack Detect Time C*
the frequency of access to MFP
features.
[0 to 9 / 3 / 1sec/step]
Sets the wait time to slow down the
5-417-003 Productivity Fall Waite C* speed of certification when an
excessive number of access attempts
have been detected.
SP Mode Tables
down the certification speed when an
Appendices:
excessive number of access attempts
have been detected.
[User Authentication]
These settings should be done with the System Administrator.
5420
These functions are enabled only after the user access feature has
been enabled.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Authentication ON
1: Authentication OFF
5-420-001 Copy C*
Determines whether certification is
required before a user can use the copy
applications.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Authentication ON
1: Authentication OFF
5-420-011 DocumentServer C*
Determines whether certification is
required before a user can use the
document server.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Authentication ON
1: Authentication OFF
5-420-021 Fax C*
Determines whether certification is
required before a user can use the fax
application.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Authentication ON
1: Authentication OFF
5-420-031 Scanner C*
Determines whether certification is
required before a user can use the
scanner applications.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Authentication ON
1: Authentication OFF
5-420-041 Printer C*
Determines whether certification is
required before a user can use the
printer applications.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Authentication ON
1: Authentication OFF
5-420-081 Browser C*
Determines whether certification is
required before a user can use the
Browser application.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-430-001 Message Chande On/Off C* Turns on or off the displayed message
change for the authentication.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-430-002 Message Text Download C*
Executes the message download for
the authentication.
[characters(max.16Byte) / 0 /-]
5-430-003 Message Text ID C* Inputs message text for the
authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the tag copy permission
5-431-010 Tag C*
for the external authentication.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the copy permission of
5-431-011 Entry C* the entry information for the external
authentication.
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the copy permission of
5-431-012 Group C* the group information for the external
authentication.
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the copy permission of
5-431-020 Mail C* the mail information for the external
authentication.
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the copy permission of
5-431-030 Fax C* the fax information for the external
authentication.
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the copy permission of
5-431-031 FaxSub C* the fax additional information for the
external authentication.
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the copy permission of
5-431-032 Folder C* the folder information for the external
authentication.
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the copy permission of
5-431-033 ProtectCode C* the protection code information for the
external authentication.
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the copy permission of
5-431-034 SmtpAuth C* the SMTP information for the external
authentication.
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the copy permission of
5-431-035 LdapAuth C* the LDAP information for the external
authentication.
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the copy permission of
5-431-036 Smb Ftp Fldr Auth C* the SMB/FTP information for the
external authentication.
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the copy permission of
5-431-037 AcntAcl C* the account ACL information for the
external authentication.
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the copy permission of
5-431-038 DocumentAcl C* the document ACL information for the
external authentication.
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the copy permission of
5-431-040 CertCrypt C* the authentication information for the
external authentication.
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the copy permission of
5-431-050 UserLimitCount C* the maximum number information for
SP Mode Tables
the external authentication.
Appendices:
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Display OFF
1: Display ON
5-481-001 System Log Disp C*
Determines whether an error code
appears in the system log after a user
authentication failure occurs.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: Display OFF
1: Display ON
5-481-002 Panel Disp C*
Determines whether an error code
appears on the operation panel after a
user authentication failure occurs.
[MF KeyCard]
5490
Sets up operation of the machine with a keycard.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Disabled. Cancels operation if no
code is input.
5-490-001 Job Permit Setting C* 1: Enabled. Allows operation if another
code is input and decrements the
counter once for use of the entered
code.
[0 or 1 / 00000000 / 1/step]
Determines whether to cancel the job
when MK1 keycard is pulled out from
the machine during job.
5-491-001 Detail Option C* bit0: Forced Job Canceling
0: On. Cancels the job.
1: Off. Allows operation if MK1 keycard
is pulled out from the machine during
the job.
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Alarm off
5-501-001 PM Alarm Level C*
1 to 9999: Alarm goes off when Value (1
to 9999) x 1000 > PM counter
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: No alarm sounds
5-501-002 Original Count Alarm C* 1: Alarm sounds after the number of
originals passing through the ADF >
10,000
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1/step]
0: Zero (Off)
1: Low (2.5K jams)
2: Medium (3K jams)
5-504-001 - C*
3: High (6K jams)
Sets the alarm to sound for the
specified jam level (document misfeeds
are not included).
[Error Alarm]
Sets the error alarm level.
The error alarm counter counts "1" when any SC is detected. However, the
5505
error alarm counter decreases by "1" when an SC is not detected during a
set number of copied sheets (for example, default 700 sheets).
The error alarm occurs when the SC error alarm counter reaches "5".
[0 to 255 / 15 / 1hundred/step]
5-505-001 - C*
0: Alarm Off
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[Supply/CC Alarm]
5507
Enables or disables the notifying a supply call via the @Remote.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Switches the control call on/off for the
paper supply. DFU
0: No alarm
5-507-001 Paper Supply Alarm C*
1: Sets the alarm to sound for the
specified number transfer sheets for
each paper size (A3, A4, B4, B5, DLT,
LG, LT, HLT)
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Switches the control call on/off for the
stapler installed in the finisher. DFU
5-507-003 Toner Supply Alarm C* If you select "1" the alarm will sound
when the copier detects toner end.
0: Off
1: On
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-507-004 MaintenanceKIt C* 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-507-005 DrumLifeRermain C* 0: OFF
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Toner Collection Bottle
5-507-006 C* 0: OFF
Alarm
1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: At replacement
1: AtLessThanThresh
5-507-080 Toner Call Timing C*
Changes the timing of the "Toner Supply
Call" via the @Remote, when the
following conditions occur.
5-507-133 Interval: A4 C*
5-507-166 Interval: LT C*
[3 to 30 / 10 / 1min./step]
5-508-011 Jam Detection: Time Length C* Sets the length of time to determine
paper jams required to initiate a call.
[2 to 10 / 5 / 1time/step]
Jam Detection: Continuous
5-508-012 C* Sets the number of continuous paper
Count
jams required to initiate a call.
[3 to 30 / 10 / 1min./step]
5-508-013 Door Open: Time Length C* Sets the length of time the door remains
open before the machine initiates a call.
[SC/Alarm Setting]
With NRS (New Remote Service) in use, these SP codes can be set to
5515
issue an SC call when an SC error occurs. If this SP is switched off, the SC
call is not issued when an SC error occurs.
5-515-001 SC Call C*
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
5-515-004 User Call C*
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Disable/Enable Setting
5-516-001 C* 0: Not send
(0:Not Send,1:Send)
1: Send
5-611-001 B-C E*
5-611-002 B-M E*
5-611-003 G-C E*
[0 to 128 / 100 / 1/step]
5-611-004 G-Y E*
5-611-005 R-M E*
5-611-006 R-Y E*
[Counter Effect]
5731
Converts the paper count to the combine count for MK-1 counter.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-734-001 PDF/A Fixed C* 0: All PDF categories
1: PDF/A only
5-741-001 - C* [- / - / -]
[DeemedPowerConsumption]
5745
Displays the deemed power consumption of each condition.
5-745-212 STR C*
5-745-215 Printing C*
5-745-216 Scanning C*
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
5-745-218 Low Power Consumption C*
[Import/Export]
5749
Imports and exports preference information.
5-749-001 Export C* [- / - / -]
meanings
bit Setting Description
0 1
bit 3 Reserved - - -
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
If it is “1”, the machine can be
used Scanner Simple UI. If it
bit 4 Simple UI Function Disabled Enabled is “0”, requesting URL of
Simple UI returns “404 Not
Found”
bit 6 Reserved - - -
bit 7 Reserved - - -
[Display Setting]
5755
Sets the display for the administrator password.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Disp Administrator
5-755-001 C Displays the password setting screen
Password Change Scrn
for the supervisor and administrator 1 in
the startup after the execution.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Hide Administrator
5-755-002 C Hides the input screen of the
Password Change Scrn
administrator password temporarily
after the execution.
[ - / - / -]
[Execute]
5-801-001 All Clear C Initializes items 002 to 027.
Take a memo of the settings prior to
execute this SP
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-801-002 Engine E Initializes all registration settings for the
engine and copy process settings.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
Initializes default system settings, SCS
5-801-003 SCS C
(System Control Service) settings,
operation display coordinates, and
ROM update information.
[-/-/-]
5-801-004 IMH Memory Clr C
[Execute]
[-/-/-]
5-801-005 MCS C [Execute]
Initializes the Mcs settings.
[-/-/-]
5-801-006 Copier Application C [Execute]
Initializes all copier application settings.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
5-801-007 FAX Application C Initializes the fax reset time, job login
ID, all TX/RX settings, local storage file
numbers, and off-hook timer.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
The following service settings:
Bit switches
Gamma settings (User & Service)
Toner Limit
The following user settings:
5-801-008 Printer Application C
Tray Priority
Menu Protect
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
System Setting except for setting of
Energy Saver
I/F Setup (I/O Buffer and I/O
Timeout)
PCL Menu
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
5-801-009 Scanner Application C
Initializes the scanner defaults for the
scanner and all the scanner SP modes.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
5-801-010 Web Service C Deletes the network file application
management files and thumbnails, and
initializes the job login ID.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
5-801-011 NCS C All setting of Network Setup (User
Menu)
(NCS: Network Control Service)
[-/-/-]
5-801-012 R-Fax C [Execute]
Initializes the R-FAX settings.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
5-801-014 Clear DCS Setting C
Initializes the DCS (Delivery Control
Service) settings.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
5-801-015 Clear UCS Setting C
Initializes the UCS (User Information
Control Service) settings.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
5-801-016 MIRS Setting C
Initializes the MIRS (Machine
Information Report Service) settings.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
5-801-017 CCS C
Initializes the CCS (Certification and
Charge-control Service) settings.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
5-801-018 SRM Memory Clr C
Initializes the SRM (System Resource
Manager) settings.
[-/-/-]
5-801-019 LCS C [Execute]
Initializes the LCS settings.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
5-801-020 WebUapli C
Initializes the Web user application
settings.
[-/-/-]
5-801-021 ECS C [Execute]
Initializes the ECS settings.
[-/-/-]
5-801-023 AICS C
Initializes the AICS settings.
[-/-/-]
5-801-024 BROWSER C
Initializes the Browser settings.
5-801-025 Websys C
[-/-/-]
5-801-026 PLN C
[Execute]
5-801-027 SAS C
[INPUT Check]
5803
See “page 3-212”
[OUTPUT Check]
5804
See “page 3-214”
[SC Reset]
SP Mode Tables
5810
Appendices:
Cancel SC of the CE cancellation.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-810-001 Fusing SC Reset E
[Execute]
5811 [MachineSerial]
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
5-811-002 Display E*
Displays the machine serial number.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
5-811-004 BCU E
Inputs the serial number.
[up to 20 / - / 1/step]
Sets the telephone number for a
service representative. This number is
printed on the Counter List, which can
5-812-001 Service C* be printed with the user’s “Counter”
menu.
This can be up to 20 characters (both
numbers and alphabetic characters can
be input).
[up to 20 / - / 1/step]
Sets the fax or telephone number for a
service representative. This number is
5-812-002 Facsimile C* printed on the Counter List.
This can be up to 20 characters (both
numbers and alphabetic characters can
be input).
[up to 20 / - / 1/step]
Use this to input the telephone number
5-812-003 Supply C*
of your supplier for consumables. Enter
the number and press #.
[up to 20 / - / 1/step]
Use this to input the telephone number
5-812-004 Operation C*
of your sales agency. Enter the number
and press #.
[0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step]
0: Remote service off
5-816-001 I/F Setting C* 1: CSS remote service on
2: NRS remote service on
Selects the remote service setting.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Start of the service
1: End of the service
5-816-002 CE Call C* Performs the CE Call at the start or end
of the service.
Note: This SP is activated only when
SP5816-001 is set to “1”.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
Enables or disables the remote service
5-816-003 Function Flag C*
function.
NOTE: This SP setting is changed to "1"
after @Remote register has been
completed.
SP Mode Tables
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Appendices:
0: No. SSL used.
1: Yes. SSL not used.
5-816-007 SSL Disable C* Controls if RCG (Remote Communication
Gate) confirmation is done by SSL during
an RCG send for the @Remote over a
network interface.
[1 to 90 / 30 / 1second/step]
Sets the length of time (seconds) for the
5-816-008 RCG Connect Timeout C* time-out when the RCG (Remote
Communication Gate) connects during a
call via the @Remote network.
[0 to 100 / 60 / 1second/step]
Sets the length of time (seconds) for the
5-816-009 RCG Write Timeout C* time-out when sent data is written to the
RCG during a call over the @Remote
network.
[0 to 100 / 60 / 1second/step]
Sets the length of time (seconds) for the
5-816-010 RCG Read Timeout C* timeout when sent data is written from the
RCG during a call over the @Remote
network.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: No. Access denied
1: Yes. Access granted
5-816-011 Port 80 Enable C*
Controls if permission is given to get
access to the SOAP method over Port 80
on the @Remote network.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: RFU is executed whenever update
request is received.
5-816-013 RFU Timing C* 1: RFU is executed only when the
machine is in the sleep mode.
Selects the timing for the remote
firmware updating.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Initial state, normal condition
5-816-014 RCG Error Cause C*
1: Error
Displays RCG connection error. cause
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Initial state, normal condition
5-816-021 RCG-C Registed C* 1: Error
Displays the Embedded RC Gate
installation end flag.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Initial state, normal condition
5-816-023 Connect Type(N/M) C* 1: Error
Displays/selects the Embedded RC Gate
connection method.
[-/0/-]
5-816-061 Cert Expire Timing C* Proximity of the expiration of the
certification.
[-/-/-]
Determines if the proxy server is used
5-816-062 Use Proxy C*
when the machine communicates with
the service center.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
The address display is limited to
128 characters. Characters
beyond the 128 character are
ignored.
This address is customer
information and is not printed in
the SMC report.
[0 to 0xffff / 0 / 1/step]
This SP sets the port number of the proxy
server used for communication between
the embedded RCG-N and the gateway.
This setting is necessary to set up the
5-816-064 Proxy PortNumber C*
embedded RC Gate-N.
[up to 31 / - / 1/step]
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification
user name.
[up to 31 / - / 1/step]
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification
password.
[-/-/-]
CERT:Up State C* Displays the status of the certification
update.
5-816-067 The period of the certification has expired and new request for an
4
update is being sent to the GW URL.
The certification has been stored, and the GW URL is being notified
15
of the successful completion of this event.
The storing of the certification has failed, and the GW URL is being
16
notified of the failure of this event.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
The rescue certification of No. 17 has been recorded, and the GW
18
URL is being notified of the failure of the certification update.
[-/-/-]
Displays a number code that describes
CERT:Error C*
the reason for the request for update of
the certification.
5-816-068 An SSL error notification has been issued. Issued after the
2
certification has expired.
[-/-/-]
5-816-069 CERT:Up ID C*
The ID of the request for certification.
[-/-/-]
5-816-083 Firm Up Status C* Displays the status of the firmware
update.
[-/-/-]
Determines if the operator can confirm
the previous version of the firmware
before the firmware update execution. If
5-816-085 Firm Up User Check C* the option to confirm the previous version
is selected, a notification is sent to the
system manager and the firmware
update is done with the firmware files
from the URL.
[-/-/-]
Allows the service technician to confirm
5-816-086 Firmware Size C*
the size of the firmware data files during
the firmware update execution.
[-/-/-]
5-816-087 CERT:Macro Ver. C* Displays the macro version of the
@Remote certification.
[-/-/-]
5-816-088 CERT:PAC Ver. C* Displays the PAC version of the
@Remote certification.
[-/-/-]
Displays ID2 for the @Remote
certification. Spaces are displayed as
5-816-089 CERT:ID2Code C* underscores (_). Asterisks (*) indicate
that no @Remote certification exists.
"000000___________" indicates
"Common certification".
[-/-/-]
Displays the common name of the
@Remote certification subject. CN = the
following 17 bytes. Spaces are displayed
5-816-090 CERT:Subject C*
as underscores (_). Asterisks (*) indicate
that no @Remote certification exists.
"000000___________" indicates
"Common certification".
[-/-/-]
Displays serial number for the @Remote
5-816-091 CERT:SerialNo. C*
certification. Asterisks (*) indicate that no
@Remote certification exists.
[-/-/-]
Displays the common name of the issuer
5-816-092 CERT:Issuer C* of the @Remote certification. CN = the
following 30 bytes. Asterisks () indicate
SP Mode Tables
that no @Remote certification exists.
Appendices:
[-/-/-]
Displays the start time of the period for
5-816-093 CERT:Valid Start C*
which the current @Remote certification
is enabled.
[-/-/-]
Displays the end time of the period for
5-816-094 CERT: Valid End C*
which the current @Remote certification
is enabled.
[-/1/-]
5-816-102 CERT:Encrypt Level C* Displays cryptic strength of the NRS
certification.
[-/-/-]
5-816-200 Manual Polling C* [Execute]
Executes the center polling manually.
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1/step]
Displays a number that indicates the
status of the @Remote service device.
0: Neither the @Remote device nor
Embedded RCG Gate is set.
1: The Embedded RCG Gate is being
set. Only Box registration is completed. In
this status, @Remote device cannot
5-816-201 Regist Status C*
communicate with this device.
2: The Embedded RCG Gate is set. In
this status, the @Remote device cannot
communicate with this device.
3: The @Remote device is being set. In
this status the Embedded RCG Gate
cannot be set.
4: The @Remote module has not started.
[-/-/-]
5-816-202 Letter Number C* Allows entry of the request number
needed for the Embedded RCG Gate.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
5-816-203 Confirm Execute C*
Executes the confirmation request to the
@Remote Gateway.
[0 to 255/ 0 / 1/step]
Displays a number that indicates the
result of the inquiry executed with
SP5816-203.
0: Succeeded
1: Inquiry number error
5-816-204 Confirm Result C* 3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)
4: Proxy error (proxy disabled)
5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or
password)
6: Communication error
8: Other error
9: Inquiry executing
[-/-/-]
Displays the result of the notification sent
to the device from the GW URL in answer
5-816-205 Confirm Place C*
to the inquiry request. Displayed only
when the result is registered at the GW
URL.
[-/-/-]
5-816-206 Register Execute C* [Execute]
SP Mode Tables
Executes "Embedded RCG Registration".
Appendices:
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
Displays a number that indicates the
registration result.
0: Succeeded
1: Inquiry number error
2: Registration in progress
5-816-207 Register Result C*
3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)
4: Proxy error (proxy disabled)
5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or
password)
8: Other error
9: Registration executing
@Remote communication is
prohibited. The device has an
-12005
Embedded RC gate-related
problem.
D2 mismatch between an
-12009 individual certification and
NVRAM.
[- / - / -]
SP Mode Tables
[Execute]
Appendices:
5-816-209 Instl Clear C
Releases the machine from its
embedded RCG setup.
5-816-240 CommErrorTime C
5-816-241 CommErrorCode 1 C [- / - / -]
5-816-243 CommErrorCode 3 C
5-816-244 CommErrorState 1 C
[- / - / -]
5-816-245 CommErrorState 2 C
[Execute]
5-816-246 CommErrorState 3 C
[- / - / -]
5-816-250 CommLog Print C
[Execute]
[00000000h to FFFFFFFFh /
00000000h / 1/step]
Sets the IP address of the RCG
5-821-002 RCG IP Address C*
(Remote Communication Gate)
destination for call processing at the
remote service center.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Uploads the NVRAM data to an SD
5-824-001 - C*
card. Push Execute.
Note: When uploading data in this SP
mode, the front door must be open.
[- / - / -]
5-825-001 - C
[Execute]
[Network Setting]
5828
Job spool settings/ Interface selection for Ethernet and wireless LAN
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-828-050 1284 Compatiblity (Centro) C* Enables or disables 1284 Compatibility.
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Displays/sets the ECP.
0: not allowed
5-828-052 ECP (Centro) C*
1: allowed
The 1284 mode must be allowed when
the ECP allowed.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
Switches the job spooling on and off.
5-828-065 Job Spooling C*
0: No spooling
1: Spooling enabled
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Determines whether the job interrupted
at power off is resumed at the next
Job Spooling Clear: Start
5-828-066 C* power on. This SP operates only when
Time
SP Mode Tables
SP5828-065 is set to "1".
Appendices:
0: ON
1: OFF
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Determines whether job spooling is
Job Spooling (Protocol) C*
enabled or disabled for each protocol.
This is an 8-bit setting.
[-/-/-]
Shows which protocols have been used
with the network.
0: Off (Not used the network with the
protocol.)
1: On (Used the network with the
protocol once or more.)
bit0: IPsec, bit1: IPv6, bit2: IEEE 802.
1X, bit3:Wireless LAN,
bit4: Security mode level setting,
bit5:Appletalk, bit6: DHCP,
bit7: DHCPv6, bit8: telnet, bit9: SSL,
bit10: HTTPS,
5-828-087 Protocol usage C* bit11: BMLinkS printing, bit12: diprint
printing, bit13: LPR printing,
bit14: ftp printing, bit15: rsh printing,
bit16: SMB printing,
bit17: WSD-Printer, bit18:
WSD-Scanner, bit19: Scan to SMB,
bit20: Scan to NCP, bit21: Reserve,
bit22: Bluetooth,
bit23: IEEE 1284, bit24: USB printing,
bit25: Dynamic DNS,
bit26: Netware printing, bit27: LLTD,
bit28: IPP printing,
bit29: IPP printing (SSL), bit30: ssh,
bit31: sftp
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-828-090 TELNET(0:OFF 1:ON) C* Enables or disables the Telnet protocol.
0: Disable, 1: Enable
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-828-091 Web (0:OFF 1:ON) C* Enables or disables the Web operation.
0: Disable, 1: Enable
[-/-/-]
This is the IPv6 local address link
referenced on the Ethernet or wireless
Active IPv6 Link Local LAN (802.11b) in the format:
5-828-145 C*
Address "Link Local Address" + "Prefix Length"
The IPv6 address consists of a total
128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16
bits each.
SP Mode Tables
Active IPv6 Stateless
Appendices:
5-828-147 C*
Address 1
[-/-/-]
Active IPv6 Stateless These SPs are the IPv6 status
5-828-149 C*
Address 2 addresses (1 to 5) referenced on the
Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11b) in
Active IPv6 Stateless
5-828-151 C* the format:
Address 3
"Status Address" + "Prefix Length"
Active IPv6 Stateless The IPv6 address consists of a total
5-828-153 C*
Address 4 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16
bits each.
Active IPv6 Stateless
5-828-155 C*
Address 5
[-/-/-]
This SP is the IPv6 manually set
address referenced on the Ethernet or
wireless LAN (802.11b) in the format:
5-828-156 IPv6 Manual Adress C*
"Manual Set Address" + "Prefix Length"
The IPv6 address consists of a total
128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16
bits each.
[-/-/-]
This SP is the IPv6 gateway address
referenced on the Ethernet or wireless
5-828-158 IPv6 Gateway Adress C*
LAN (802.11b). The IPv6 address
consists of a total 128 bits configured in
8 blocks of 16 bits each.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
Enables or disables the automatic
5-828-161 IPv6 Stateless Auto Setting C*
setting for IPv6 stateless.
0: Disable, 1: Enable
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
Displays or does not display the link to
Net RICOH on the top page and link
5-828-237 Web shopping link visible C*
page of the web system.
0: Not display
1: Display
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
Displays or does not display the link to
Consumable Supplier on the top page
5-828-238 Web Supplies link visible C*
and link page of the web system.
0: Not display
1: Display
[-/-/-]
Confirms or changes the URL1 name
5-828-239 Web Link1 Name C* on the link page of the web system. The
maximum characters for the URL name
are 31 characters.
[-/-/-]
Confirms or changes the link to URL1
5-828-240 Web Link1 URL C* on the link page of the web system. The
maximum characters for the URL are
127 characters.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Displays or does not display the link to
5-828-241 Web Link1 visible C*
URL1 on the top page of the web
system.
[-/-/-]
5-828-242 Web Link2 Name C*
Same as "-239"
[-/-/-]
5-828-243 Web Link2 URL C*
Same as "-240"
[-/1/-]
5-828-244 Web Link2 visible C*
Same as "-241"
[-/-/-]
5-828-249 DHCPv6 DUID C*
SP Mode Tables
Sets DHCPv6 DUID.
Appendices:
[HDD]
5832
Initializes the hard disk. Use this SP mode only if there is a hard disk error.
HDD Formatting
5-832-003 C
(Thumbnail) [- / - / -]
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
Capture Function (0:Off
5-836-001 C* With this function disabled, the settings
1:On)
related to the capture feature cannot be
initialized, displayed, or selected.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Displayed, 1: Not displayed
5-836-002 Panel Setting C*
Displays or does not display the
capture function buttons.
[0 to 6 / 0 / 1/step]
0: 1
1: 1/2
5-836-075 Reduction for Printer B&W C*
2: 1/3
3: 1/4
6: 2/3
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1/step]
Sets the JPEG format default for
documents sent to the document
management server with the MLB, with
5-836-091 Default for JPEG C*
JPEG selected as the format. Enabled
only when optional File Format
Converter (MLB: Media Link Board) is
installed.
SP Mode Tables
5-836-092 High Quality for JPEG C* [5 to 95 / 60 / 1/step]
Appendices:
5-836-093 Low Quality for JPEG C* [5 to 95 / 40 / 1/step]
[-/2/-]
0: 1/1
Default Resolution for Back
5-836-095 C* 1: 1/2
Up Files
2: 1/3
3: 1/4
[-/-/-]
Sets the IP address for the primary
5-836-101 Primary srv IP adress C*
capture server. This is basically
adjusted by the remote system.
[-/-/-]
5-836-102 Primary srv Scheme C* This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
[ - / 80 / - ]
5-836-103 Primary srv port number C* This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
[-/-/-]
Sets the IP address for the primary
5-836-104 Primary srv URL path C*
capture server. This is basically
adjusted by the remote system.
[-/-/-]
5-836-111 Secondary srv IP adress C* This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
[-/-/-]
5-836-112 Secondary srv scheme C* This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
[ - / 80 / - ]
5-836-113 Secondary srv port number C* This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
[-/-/-]
5-836-114 Secondary srv URL path C* This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-836-120 Default Reso Rate Switch C* This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
[0 to 6 / 3 / 1/step]
Selects the resolution for BW copy
mode. This is basically adjusted by the
remote system.
0: 600dpi
5-836-122 Reso: Copy(Mono) C* 1: 400dpi
2: 300dpi
3: 200dpi
4: 150dpi
5: 100dpi
6: 75dpi
[0 to 6 / 3 / 1/step]
Selects the resolution for BW copy
mode. This is basically adjusted by the
remote system.
0: 600dpi
5-836-124 Reso: Print(Mono) C* 1: 400dpi
2: 300dpi
3: 200dpi
4: 150dpi
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
5: 100dpi
6: 75dpi
[0 to 6 / 3 / 1/step]
Selects the resolution for BW fax mode.
This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
0: 600dpi
5-836-126 Reso: Fax(Mono) C* 1: 400dpi
2: 300dpi
3: 200dpi
4: 150dpi
5: 100dpi
6: 75dpi
[0 to 6 / 4 / 1/step]
Selects the resolution for color
scanning mode. This is basically
adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi
5-836-127 Reso: Scan(Color) C* 1: 400dpi
2: 300dpi
3: 200dpi
4: 150dpi
5: 100dpi
6: 75dpi
[0 to 6 / 3 / 1/step]
Selects the resolution for BW scanning
mode. This is basically adjusted by the
remote system.
0: 600dpi
5-836-128 Reso: Scan(Mono) C* 1: 400dpi
2: 300dpi
3: 200dpi
4: 150dpi
5: 100dpi
6: 75dpi
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Turns on or off the all address
information transmission for the
5-836-141 All Addr Info Switch C*
captured resources.
0: Off
1: On
[ - / 14 / - ]
5-840-006 Channel MAX C*
DFU
[-/1/-]
5-840-007 Channel MAX C*
DFU
[ - / 00000000 / -]
5-840-011 WEP Key Select C*
Selects the WEP key.
[1 to 3 / 3 / 1/step]
Selects the debug level for WPA
authentication application.
This SP is displayed only when the
5-840-045 WPA debug Lvl C*
IEEE802.11 card is installed.
1: Info
2: warning
3: error
SP Mode Tables
5-840-046 11w C* [0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
Appendices:
5-840-047 PSK Set Type C* [0 to 1 / 0 / 1/step]
[- / - / -]
5-841-001 Toner Name Setting: Black C* The top 1 byte: character code scheme
Rest 20 bytes: character string
[GWWS Analysis]
5842 This is a debugging tool. It sets the debugging output mode of each Net
File process.
5-842-001 Setting 1 C*
[- / 00000000 / -]
5-842-002 Setting 2 C*
5844 [USB]
[ - / 0x04 / - ]
Sets the speed for USB data
5-844-001 Transfer Rate C* transmission.
0x01: Full Speed
0x04: Auto Change
[ - / 5CAh / - ]
5-844-002 Vendor ID C*
DFU
[ - / 403h / - ]
5-844-003 Product ID C*
DFU
[ - / 100 / - ]
5-844-004 Device Release Number C*
DFU
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
Standardizes for common use the
model name and serial number for USB
PnP (Plug & Play). It determines
5-844-005 Fixed USB Port C* whether the driver requires
re-installation.
0: OFF
1: Level1
2: Level2
[up to 20 characters / - / - ]
Sets the model name to be used by the
USB PnP when "Function Enable
5-844-006 PnP Model Name C*
(Level 2) is set so the USB Serial No.
can have a common name
(SP5-844-005).
[-/-/-]
Sets the serial number to be used by
the USB PnP when "Function Enable
(Level 2) set so the USB Serial No. can
have a common name (SP5-844-005).
Make sure that this entry is the
same as the serial number in use.
5-844-007 PnP Serial Number C*
At initialization the serial number
generated from the model name is
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
used, not the setting of this SP
code.
At times other than initialization,
the value set for this SP code is
used.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
5-844-008 Mac Supply Level C* 0: OFF
1: ON
[000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255 /
- / 1/step]
Use this SP to set the Scan Router
5-845-002 IP Address (Primary) C*
Server address. The IP address under
the transfer tab can be used with the
initial system setting.
[-/-/-]
Sets the IP address that is given to the
computer that is the secondary delivery
5-845-008 IP Address (Secondary) C*
server for Scan Router. This SP lets
you set only the IP address, and does
not refer to the DNS setting.
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1/step]
Allows changing the model of the
5-845-009 Delivery Server Model C*
delivery server registered by the I/O
device.
Changes the capability of the registered that the I/O device registered.
Bit7 = 1 Comment information exits
Bit6 = 1 Direct specification of mail address possible
[ Up to 6 char / - / -/step]
5-845-013 Server Scheme (Primary) C* This SP is used for the scan router
program.
[1 to 65535 / 80 / 1/step]
Server Port Number
5-845-014 C* This SP is used for the scan router
(Primary)
program.
[ Up to 16 byte / - / -/step]
5-845-015 Server URL Path (Primary) C* This SP is used for the scan router
program.
[ Up to 6 char / - / -/step]
Server Scheme
5-845-016 C* This SP is used for the scan router
(Secondary)
program.
[1 to 65535 / 80 / 1/step]
Server Port Number
5-845-017 C* This SP is used for the scan router
(Secondary)
program.
[ Up to 16 byte / - / -/step]
Server URL Path
5-845-018 C* This SP is used for the scan router
(Secondary)
program.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -/step]
0: Control disabled
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
1: Control enabled
5-845-022 Rapid Sending Control C*
Enables or disables the prevention
function for the continuous data
sending error.
[ - / - / -]
Displays the unique device ID in use by
the delivery server directory. The value
Machine ID (for Delivery is only displayed and cannot be
5-846-001 C*
Server) changed. This ID is created from the
NIC MAC or IEEE 1394 EUI. The ID is
displayed as either 6-byte or 8-byte
binary.
[ - / - / -]
[Execute]
Clears the unique ID of the device used
as the name in the file transfer
Machine ID Clear(for directory. Execute this SP if the
5-846-002 C*
Delivery Server) connection of the device to the delivery
server is unstable. After clearing the ID,
the ID will be established again
automatically by cycling the machine off
and on.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the interval for retry attempts when
5-846-006 Delivery Server Retry Timer C*
the delivery server fails to acquire the
delivery server address book.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
Delivery Server Retry Sets the number of retry attempts when
5-846-007 C*
Times the delivery server fails to acquire the
delivery server address book.
[1 to 255 / 60 / 1/step]
5-846-010 LDAP Search Timeout C* Sets the length of the timeout for the
search of the LDAP server.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-846-021 Folder Auth Change C*
0: Login User, 1: Destination
Addr Book [ - / - / -]
5-846-040 C
Migration(USB->HDD) [Execute]
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
This SP must be executed immediately
after installation of an HDD unit in a
basic machine that previously had no
HDD. The first time the machine is
powered on with the new HDD
installed, the system automatically
takes the address book from the
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
NVRAM and writes it onto the new
HDD. However, the new address book
on the HDD can be accessed only by
the system administrator at this stage.
Executing this SP by the service
technician immediately after power on
grants full address book access to all
5-846-041 Fill Addr Acl Info C*
users.
Procedure
1. Turn the machine off.
2. Install the new HDD.
3. Turn the machine on.
4. The address book and its initial
data are created on the HDD
automatically.
5. However, at this point the address
book can be accessed by only the
system administrator or key
operator.
6. Enter the SP mode and do
SP5846-041. After this SP
executes successfully, any user
can access the address book.
[0 to 30 / 0 /1/step]
0: Unconfirmed
1: SD Slot 1
2: SD Slot 2
5-846-043 Addr Book Media C* 3: SD Slot 3
4: USB Flash ROM
10: SD Slot 10
20: HDD
30: Nothing
[-/-/-]
Initialize Local Address [Execute]
5-846-047 C
Book Clears the local address book
information, including the user code.
[-/-/-]
Initialize Delivery Addr [Execute]
5-846-048 C
Book Clears the distribution address book
information, except the user code.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
5-846-049 Initialize LDAP Addr Book C
Clears the LDAP address book
information, except the user code.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
5-846-050 Initialize All Addr Book C Clears all directory information
managed by UCS, including all user
codes.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
5-846-051 Backup All Addr Book C
Uploads all directory information to the
SD card.
[-/-/-]
[Execute]
5-846-052 Restore All Addr Book C
Downloads all directory information
from the SD card.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Deletes the address book data from the
SD card in the service slot.
Deletes only the files that were
uploaded from this machine.
This feature does not work if the card is
5-846-053 Clear Backup Info C
write-protected.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
After you do this SP, go out of
the SP mode, and then turn the
power off. Do not remove the
SD card until the Power LED
stops flashing.
[0 to 32 / 0 / 1/step]
Use this SP to set the conditions for
password entry to access the local
address book. Specifically, this SP
limits the password entry to upper case
and sets the length of the password.
[0 to 32 / 0 / 1/step]
Use this SP to set the conditions for
password entry to access the local
5-846-063 Complexity Option 2 C*
address book. Specifically, this SP
limits the password entry to lower case
and defines the length of the password.
[0 to 32 / 0 / 1/step]
Use this SP to set the conditions for
password entry to access the local
5-846-064 Complexity Option 3 C*
address book. Specifically, this SP
limits the password entry to numbers
and defines the length of the password.
[0 to 32 / 0 / 1/step]
Use this SP to set the conditions for
password entry to access the local
5-846-065 Complexity Option 4 C*
address book. Specifically, this SP
limits the password entry to symbols
and defines the length of the password.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
5-847-005 Rate for Printer B&W C*
[- / 50 / -]
Sets the default value for the quality of
Network Quality Default for JPEG images sent as NetFile pages.
5-847-021 C*
JPEG This function is available only with the
MLB (Media Link Board) option
installed.
[Web Service]
5848
Sets the 4-bit switch assignment for the access control setting.
Access Ctrl:
5-848-022 uadministration (Lower C*
4bits)
Repository: Download
5-848-100 C* [1 to 2048 / 2048 / 1MByte/step]
Image Max. Size
[Installation Date]
5849
Displays or prints the installation date of the machine.
[- / - / -]
Displays the installation date. The
5-849-001 Display C* installation date is set automatically
after test copies are done at the
installation site.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: OFF (No Print)
1: ON (Print)
5-849-002 Switch to Print C*
Determines whether the installation
date is printed on the printout for the
total counter.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
5-849-003 Total Counter C* Displays the total counts at the installed
date (SP5-849-001).
5851 [Bluetooth]
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the operation mode for the
5-851-001 Mode C* Bluetooth Unit.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
0: Public
1: Private
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-856-002 Local Port C* 0: Disable
1: Enable
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 / -]
0: OFF
1: ON
5-857-001 On/Off C*
Switches on the debug log feature. The
debug log cannot be captured until this
feature is switched on.
[ 1 to 3 / 2 / 1/step]
1: IC Card
2: HDD
3: SD Card
5-857-002 Target (2:HDD 3:SD) C*
Selects the destination where the
debugging information generated by
the event selected by SP5-858 will be
stored if an error is generated.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Saves the debug log of the input SC
number in memory to the HDD.
5-857-005 Save to HDD C* A unique file name is generated to
avoid overwriting existing file names on
the SD Card. Up to 4MB can be copied
to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can be
copied one by one to each SD Card.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-857-006 Save to SD Card C*
Specifies the decimal key number of the
log to be written to the SD card.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Takes the most recent 4 MB of the log
written to the hard disk and copies them
Copy HDD to SD Card to the SD Card.
5-857-009 C*
(Latest 4MB) A unique file name is generated to
avoid overwriting existing file names on
the SD Card. Up to 4MB can be copied
to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can be
copied one by one to each SD Card.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Takes the log of the specified key from
the log on the hard disk and copies it to
the SD Card.
Copy HDD to SD Card A unique file name is generated to
5-857-010 C*
(Latest 4MB Any Key) avoid overwriting existing file names on
the SD Card. Up to 4 MB can be copied
to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can be
copied one by one to each SD Card.
This SP does not execute if there is no
log on the HDD and no key specified.
[- / - / -]
5-857-011 Erase HDD Debug Data C* [Execute]
Erases all debug logs on the HDD.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Erases all debug logs on the SD Card.
If the card contains only debugging files
5-857-012 Erase SD Card Debug Data C* generated by an event specified by
SP Mode Tables
SP5858, the files are erased when
Appendices:
SP5857 010 or 011 is executed.
To enable this SP, the machine must be
cycled off and on.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-857-013 Free Space on SD Card C*
Displays the amount of space available
on the SD card.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Copy SD to SD (Latest
5-857-014 C* Copies the last 4MB of the log (written
4MB)
directly to the card from shared
memory) onto an SD card.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
Copy SD to SD (Latest Copies the log on an SD card (the file
5-857-015 C*
4MB Any Key) that contains the information written
directly from shared memory) to a log
specified by key number.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-857-016 Make HDD Debug C*
Creates a 32 MB file to store a log on
the HDD.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-857-017 Make SD Debug C*
Creates a 4 MB file to store a log on the
SD card.
[ - / 20120101 / 1/step]
5-857-101 Debug Logging Start Date C*
Sets start date of the debug log output.
[ - / 20371212 / -]
5-857-102 Debug Logging End Date C*
Sets end date of the debug log output.
[-/-/-]
5-857-103 Aquire All Debug Logs C* [Execute]
Obtains all debug logs.
[-/-/-]
Aquire Only Contoroller
5-857-104 C* [Execute]
Debug Logs
Obtains controller debug logs.
[-/-/-]
Aquire Only Engine Debug
5-857-105 C* [Execute]
Logs
Obtains engine debug logs.
[-/-/-]
Aquire Only Snapshot
5-857-106 C* [Execute]
Debug Logs
Obtains snapshot debug logs.
[-/-/-]
Aquire Only Opepanel [Execute]
5-857-107 C*
Debug Logs Obtains controller debug logs to the
media inserted front I/F.
[- / - / -]
5-857-120 Make LogTrace Dir C*
[Execute]
Engine SC Error
5-858-001 C* [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/ step]
(0: OFF, 1: ON)
0: OFF
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
Controller SC Error 1: ON
5-858-002 C*
(0: OFF, 1: ON)
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/ step]
0: OFF
5-858-004 Jam(0: OFF 1: ON) C*
1: ON
Stores jam errors.
5-859-001 Key 1 C*
5-859-002 Key 2 C*
5-859-003 Key 3 C*
5-859-004 Key 4 C*
5-859-005 Key 5 C*
[-999999 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
5-859-006 Key 6 C*
5-859-007 Key 7 C*
5-859-008 Key 8 C*
5-859-009 Key 9 C*
5-859-010 Key 10 C*
5860 [SMTP/POP3/IMAP4]
[1 or 168 / 72 / 1/step]
Sets the amount of time to wait before
saving a mail that breaks up during
Partial Mail Receive
5-860-020 C* reception. The received mail is
Timeout
discarded if the remaining portion of the
mail is not received during this
prescribed time.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: No
MDN Response RFC2298 1: Yes
5-860-021 C*
Compliance Determines whether RFC2298
compliance is switched on for MDN
reply mail.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: No
1: Yes
SMTP Auth. From Field
5-860-022 C* Determines whether the FROM item of
Replacement
the mail header is switched to the
validated account after the SMTP
server is validated.
[ - / 00000000 / -]
Occasionally, SMTP certification may
fail with encryption enabled for the
SMTP server. This can occur if the
SMTP server does not meet RFC
standards. In such cases you can use
this SP to set the SMTP certification
method directly. However, this SP can
be used only encryption has been
SP Mode Tables
5-860-025 SMTP Auth. Direct Setting C*
Appendices:
enabled.
Selects the authentication method for
SMTP.
Bit switch:
Bit 0: LOGIN
Bit 1: PLAIN
Bit 2: CRAM MD5
Bit 3: DIGEST MD5
Bit 4 to 7: Not used
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
Selects the MIME header type of an
S/MIME: MIME Header E-mail sent by S/MIME.
5-860-026 C*
Setting 0: Microsoft Outlook Express standard
1: Internet Draft standard
2: RFC standard
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: No (not check)
S/MIME: Authentication
5-860-028 C* 1: Yes (check)
Check
Specifys whether to check destination
certificate when sending S/MIME mail.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-866-001 Report Validity C Enables or disables the E-mail alert
function.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Adds or does not add the date field to
5-866-005 Add Date Field C the header of the alert mail.
0: Not added
1: Added
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-869-001 Mail Function C 0: Enabled
1: Disabled
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-870-001 Writing C
Writes the authentication data (used for
NRS) in the memory.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[- / - / -]
5-870-003 Initialize C
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-870-004 Writing: 2048bit C
Writes the authentication data 2048bit
(used for NRS) in the memory.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
5-873-001 MoveExec C This SP copies the application
programs from the original SD card to
another.
[- / - / -]
[Execute]
This SP copies back the application
programs from an SD card to the
5-873-002 UndoExec C
original SD card. Use this menu when
you have mistakenly copied some
programs by using "Move Exec"
(SP5873-1).
[0 or 1/ 0 / 1/step]
Enables or disables the automatic
reboot function when an SC error
occurs.
The reboot is not executed for Type A
or C SC codes.
5-875-001 Reboot Setting *C 0: The machine reboots automatically
when the machine issues an SC error
and logs the SC error code. If the same
SC occurs again, the machine does not
reboot.
1: The machine does not reboot when
an SC error occurs.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: Manual reboot
5-875-002 Reboot Type *C
1: Automatic reboot
Selects the reboot method for SC.
[Option Setup]
5878 Enables the Data Overwrite Security option or HDD Encryption Option after
installation.
[- / - / -]
5-878-001 Data Overwrite Security C
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
5-878-002 HDD Encryption C [Execute]
Executes the encryption set-up.
[- / - / -]
5-878-004 OCR Dictionary C
[Execute]
Install Procedure
1. Insert a SD card into the back SD throttle (service throttle), then start the
machine.
2. Execute SP5-878-4.
3. Switch the main power OFF/ON.
4. Execute SP5-878-4.
This SP can link the SD card at the first time execution, and can copy the
OCR dictionary at the second time execution.
It needs restart the main power before executing the second.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
You can overwrite the OCR dictionary, and the method is the same as the
first time installation. Install it with the above procedure with the new SD
card.
5-881-001 - C [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
5-885-050 DocSvr Format C* Selects the display type for the
document box list.
[5 to 20 / 10 / 1/step]
5-885-051 DocSvr Trans C* Sets the number of documents to be
displayed in the document box list.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
Selects whether the signature is added
5-885-100 Set Signature C* to the scanned documents with the
WIM when they are transmitted by an
e-mail.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Determines whether the scanned
5-885-101 Set Encryption C*
documents with the WIM are encrypted
when they are transmitted by an e-mail.
[SD GetCounter]
This SP sends a text file to an SD card inserted in SD card Slot 2 (lower
slot). The operation stores.
The file is stored in a folder created in the root directory of the SD card
called SD_COUNTER.
The file is saved as a text file (*.txt) prefixed with the number of the
5887 machine.
Insert the SD card in SD card Slot 2 (lower slot).
Select SP5887 then touch [EXECUTE].
Touch [Execute] in the message when you are prompted.
[- / - / -]
5-887-001 - C*
[Execute]
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: No authentication, No protection for
5-888-001 - C* logs
1: No authentication, Protected logs
(only an administrator can see the logs)
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[SDK Aplication Counter]
5893
Displays the counter name of each SDK application.
5-893-001 SDK-1 C
[- / - / -]
5-893-002 SDK-2 C
[Display text]
5-893-003 SDK-3 C
5-893-004 SDK-4 C
[- / - / -]
5-893-005 SDK-5 C
[Display text]
5-893-006 SDK-6 C
[ExternalCountSet]
5894
Switch the Charge Mode of External Mech Count
5-907-001 - C* [- / - / -]
[Cherry Server]
5974
Specifies which version of ScanRouter, “Light” or “Full”, is installed.
[Device Setting]
5985
Enables/disables the on-board device.
SP Mode Tables
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
Appendices:
When the "Function limitation" is set,
"On board NIC" is limited only for the
NRS or LDAP/NT authentication.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-985-002 On Board USB E* 0: Disable
1: Enable
[Mech. Counter]
5987 This SP detects that a mechanical counter device is removed. If it is
detected, SC610 occurs.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-987-001 0:OFF / 1:ON E*
0: OFF. 1: ON
5-990-022 Scanner SP C
[- / - / -]
5-990-023 Scanner User Program C [Execute]
5-990-026 Printer SP C
SP Mode Tables
[- / - / -]
Appendices:
5-992-003 User Program C [Execute]
* MFP only
[ADF Adjustment]
Adjusts the side-to-side and leading edge registration for simplex and
6006
duplex original feeding in ARDF mode.
SP6006-5 sets the maximum setting allowed for rear edge erase.
6-910-001 - E* [0 to 90 / 60 / 1sec/step]
[Total SC]
Stores total SC occurring count.
7401
If the same SC codes are detected continuously and total counter is not
SP Mode Tables
increasing, it only logs once in case of deleting other SC code logs.
Appendices:
7-401-001 SC Counter C*
[0 to 65535 / - / 1/step]
7-401-002 Total SC Counter C*
[SC History]
Logs and displays the SC codes detected.
The 10 most recently detected SC Codes are displayed on the screen, and
also can be seen on the SMC (logging) outputs.
7403
7-403-001 Latest C*
7-403-002 Latest 1 C*
7-403-004 Latest 3 C*
7-403-005 Latest 4 C*
7-403-006 Latest 5 C*
7-403-007 Latest 6 C*
7-403-009 Latest 8 C*
7-403-010 Latest 9 C*
7-401-001 Latest C*
7-401-002 Latest 1 C*
7-401-003 Latest 2 C* [- / - / -]
7-401-004 Latest 3 C*
7-401-005 Latest 4 C*
7-401-006 Latest 5 C*
7-401-007 Latest 6 C*
7-401-008 Latest 7 C* [- / - / -]
7-401-009 Latest 8 C*
7-401-010 Latest 9 C*
7-503-001 - C*
[00000 to 65535 / 0 / 1/step]
7-503-002 Total Original Counter C*
7-504-003 Tray1: On C*
7-504-004 Tray2: On C*
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
7-504-005 Tray3: On C*
7-504-009 Duplex: On C*
7-504-017 R: On C*
7-505-001 At Power On C*
7-506-005 A4 LEF C*
7-506-006 A5 LEF C*
7-506-014 B5 LEF C*
7-506-038 LT LEF C*
[0000 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step]
7-506-044 HLT LEF C*
7-506-132 A3 SEF C*
7-506-133 A4 SEF C*
7-506-134 A5 SEF C*
7-506-141 B4 SEF C*
7-506-142 B5 SEF C*
7-506-166 LT SEF C*
7-506-255 Others C*
7-507-001 Latest C*
7-507-002 Latest 1 C*
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
7-507-004 Latest 3 C*
7-507-005 Latest 4 C*
7-507-006 Latest 5 C*
7-507-007 Latest 6 C*
7-507-009 Latest 8 C*
7-507-010 Latest 9 C*
7-508-001 Latest C*
7-508-002 Latest 1 C*
7-508-003 Latest 2 C* [- / - / -]
7-508-004 Latest 3 C*
7-508-005 Latest 4 C*
7-508-006 Latest 5 C*
7-508-007 Latest 6 C*
7-508-008 Latest 7 C* [- / - / -]
7-508-009 Latest 8 C*
7-508-010 Latest 9 C*
7-514-001 At Power On C*
7-514-003 Tray 1: On C*
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
7-514-005 Tray 3: On C*
7-514-008 Bypass: On C*
7-514-009 Duplex: On C*
7-514-013 - C*
7-514-017 Resistration: On C*
7-514-023 - C*
7-514-026 - C*
7-514-053 - C*
7-514-054 - C*
7-514-063 - C*
7-515-001 At Power On C*
7-515-100 - C*
[-]
7516
Displays occurring count of transfer paper jams by each paper size.
7-516-005 A4 LEF C*
7-516-006 A5 LEF C*
7-516-038 LT LEF C*
7-516-132 A3 SEF C*
7-516-133 A4 SEF C*
7-516-141 B4 SEF C*
7-516-142 B5 SEF C*
7-516-164 LG SEF C*
7-516-255 Others C*
[Update Log]
Displays the error history of the 10 most recent firmware updates.
[-001] indicates the latest history and [-010] indicates 10 times before.
7520 Records older than 10 times will be discarded. If the recent update
successed, a success log will be recorded on the [-001]. The step of
updating is one time, hence if multiple modules updated all at once, it logs
the last one of them.
7-520-001 ErrorRecord1 C*
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
7-520-002 ErrorRecord2 C*
7-520-004 ErrorRecord4 C*
7-520-005 ErrorRecord5 C*
7-520-006 ErrorRecord6 C*
7-520-007 ErrorRecord7 C*
7-520-009 ErrorRecord9 C*
7-520-010 ErrorRecord10 C*
[Disp. PM Counter]
7803
Displays and sets the Sheets/Distance/Usage counter
[- / - / -]
7-804-001 Paper C
[Execute]
[Reset PM Counter]
7804
Counter reset by execution SP.
7-804-002 PCDU E
7-804-003 Fuser E [- / - / -]
7-804-004 Trans. E
7-804-005 Feed E
7-804-011 All E
[- / - / -]
7-805-001 Setting C*
[Execute]
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[SC/Jam Counter Reset]
Resets the SC, paper, original, and total jam counters. When the program
ends normally, the message "Completed" is displayed.
7807
SP7-807-1 does not reset the following logs: SP7-507
(Display-Paper Jam History) and SP7-508 (Display-Original Jam
History).
[- / - / -]
7-807-001 - C
[Execute]
[- / - / -]
7-827-001 - C
[Execute]
[Self-Diagnose Display]
7832 Displays the result of the diagnostics. To scroll the return codes, press the
up-arrow key or the down-arrow key.
[- / - / -]
7-832-001 - C
[Execute]
7-836-001 - C [- / - / -]
[Toner Counter]
7850
Counter resetting by execution SP.
[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1/step]
7-852-001 Dust Detection Counter E*
Dust detection counter for DF glass.
[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1/step]
Dust Detection Clear
7-852-002 E* Clear Dust detection counter for DF
Counter
glass.
[Assert Info.]
7901
Displays the detail information of SC990 that occurred lastly.
SP Mode Tables
7-901-002 Number of Lines C* [- / - / -]
Appendices:
7-901-003 Location C*
[Toner Info.]
7931 Displays the ID chip information in the toner cartridge.
Returns “0”, if it could not access to the ID chip.
7-931-001 Machine ID E
7-931-002 Version E
7-931-003 Brand ID E
7-931-004 Area ID E
7-931-006 Color ID E
7-931-007 Maintenance ID E
[PCDU Info.]
7932 Displays the ID chip information in the PCDU.
Returns “0”, if it could not access to the ID chip.
7-932-001 Machine ID E
7-932-002 Class ID E
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
7-932-003 Maintenance ID E
7-932-008 Distance E
7-932-013 Cleaning1Count E
[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1count / step]
7-932-014 Cleaning2Count E
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
7-935-005 2:Serial No. E* [- / - / -]
[PCDU Log]
7936
Displays the ID chip log data in the toner cartridge.
[0 to 2 / 1 / 1/step]
0: Earlier
7-952-001 Maintenance Kit E*
1: Normal
2: Later
[0 to 2 / 1 / 1/step]
0: Earlier
7-952-002 PCDU E*
1: Normal
2: Later
[Total Counter]
7993
Sheet number counter: Engine: Total
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
SP8401 to SP8406 The number of pages printed from the document server
SP8691 to SP8696 The number of pages sent from the document server
C: Copy application.
S: Scan application.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
server. Each counter will be discussed case by
case.
The Group 8 SP codes are limited to 17 characters, forced by the necessity of displaying them on
the small LCDs of printers and faxes that also use these SPs. Read over the list of abbreviations
below and refer to it again if you see the name of an SP that you do not understand.
Apl Application
Bk Black
C Cyan
Comb Combine
Comp Compression
Deliv Delivery
Emul Emulation
FC Full Color
Get Print Counter. For jobs 10 pages or less, this counter does
not count up. For jobs larger than 10 pages, this counter counts
GPC
up by the number that is in excess of 10 (e.g., for an 11-page
job, the counter counts up 11-10 =1)
Image Edit performed on the original with the copier GUI, e.g.
ImgEdt
border removal, adding stamps, page numbers, etc.
K Black (YMCK)
Mag Magnification
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
print jobs to be distributed evenly among the printers on the
Palm 2
network, and allows files to move around, combined, and
converted to different formats.
PC Personal Computer
Ppr Paper
Rez Resolution
Scn Scan
S-to-Email Scan-to-E-mail
Svr Server
All of the Group 8 SPs are able to reset by “SP5-801-001 Memory All Clear”.
[T:Total Jobs] C*
8001 [0 to 99999999 / - / 1/step]
These SPs count the number of times
8002 [C:Total Jobs] C*
each application is used to do a job.
These SPs reveal the number of times an application is used, not the number of pages
processed.
When an application is opened for image input or output, this counts as one job.
Interrupted jobs (paper jams, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.
Only jobs executed by the customer are counted. Jobs executed by the customer engineer
using the SP modes are not counted.
When using secure printing (when a password is required to start the print job), the job is
counted at the time when either "Delete Data" or "Specify Output" is specified.
A job is counted as a fax job when the job is stored for sending.
When a fax is received to fax memory, the F: counter increments but the L: counter does not
(the document server is not used).
A fax broadcast counts as one job for the F: counter (the fax destinations in the broadcast are
not counted separately).
A fax broadcast is counted only after all the faxes have been sent to their destinations. If one
transmission generates an error, then the broadcast will not be counted until the transmission
SP Mode Tables
only the L: counter increments.
Appendices:
When the user enters document server mode and prints data stored on the document server,
only the L: counter increments.
When an image received from Palm 2 is received and stored, the L: counter increments.
When the customer prints a report (user code list, for example), the O: counter increments.
However, for fax reports and reports executed from the fax application, the F: counter
increments.
[T:Jobs/LS] C*
8011 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
These SPs count the number of jobs
8012 [C:Jobs/LS] C*
stored to the document server by each
8013 [F:Jobs/LS] C* application, to reveal how local storage
is being used for input.
8014 [P:Jobs/LS] C*
The L: counter counts the number of
8015 [S:Jobs/LS] C* jobs stored from within the document
server mode screen at the operation
8016 [L:Jobs/LS] C*
panel.
8017 [O:Jobs/LS] C*
When a scan job is sent to the document server, the S: counter increments. When you enter
document server mode and then scan an original, the L: counter increments.
When a print job is sent to the document server, the P: counter increments.
When a network application sends data to the document server, the O: counter increments.
When an image from Palm 2 is stored on the document server, the O: counter increments.
When a fax is sent to the document server, the F: counter increments.
8021 [T:Pjob/LS] C*
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8022 [C:Pjob/LS] C*
These SPs reveal how files printed from
8023 [F:Pjob/LS] C* the document server were stored on the
document server originally.
8024 [P:Pjob/LS] C*
The L: counter counts the number of
8025 [S:Pjob/LS] C* jobs stored from within the document
server mode screen at the operation
8026 [L:Pjob/LS] C*
panel.
8027 [O:Pjob/LS] C*
When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the C:
counter increments.
When an application like DeskTopBinder merges a copy job that was stored on the document
server with a print job that was stored on the document server, the C: and P: counters both
increment.
When a job already on the document server is printed with another application, the L: counter
increments.
When a scanner job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the S:
counter increments. If the original was scanned from within document server mode, then the
L: counter increments.
When images stored on the document server by a network application (including Palm 2), are
printed with another application, the O: counter increments.
When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with a network application (Web
Image Monitor, for example), the C: counter increments.
When a fax on the document server is printed, the F: counter increments.
8031 [T:Pjob/DesApl] C*
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8032 [C:Pjob/DesApl] C*
These SPs reveal what applications
8033 [F:Pjob/DesApl] C* were used to output documents from
the document server.
8034 [P:Pjob/DesApl] C*
The L: counter counts the number of
8035 [S:Pjob/DesApl] C* jobs printed from within the document
server mode screen at the operation
8036 [L:Pjob/DesApl] C*
panel.
8037 [O:Pjob/DesApl] C*
When documents already stored on the document server are printed, the count for the
application that started the print job is incremented.
When the print job is started from a network application (Desk Top Binder, Web Image Monitor,
etc.) the L: counter increments.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
8043 [F:TX Jobs/LS] C* were later accessed for transmission
over the telephone line or over a
8044 [P:TX Jobs/LS] C*
network (attached to an e-mail, or as a
8045 [S:TX Jobs/LS] C* fax image by I-Fax).
Note: Jobs merged for sending are
8046 [L:TX Jobs/LS] C*
counted separately.
The L: counter counts the number of
jobs scanned from within the document
8047 [O:TX Jobs/LS] C*
server mode screen at the operation
panel.
When a stored copy job is sent from the document server, the C: counter increments.
When images stored on the document server by a network application or Palm2 are sent as
an e-mail, the O: counter increments.
If the send is started from Desk Top Binder or Web Image Monitor, for example, then the O:
counter increments.
[T:FIN Jobs]
8061 These SPs total the finishing methods. The finishing method is specified
by the application.
[P:FIN Jobs]
8062 These SPs total finishing methods for print jobs only. The finishing method
is specified by the application.
[F:FIN Jobs]
8063 These SPs total finishing methods for print jobs only. The finishing method
is specified by the application.
[P:FIN Jobs]
8064 These SPs total finishing methods for print jobs only. The finishing method
is specified by the application.
[S:FIN Jobs]
These SPs total finishing methods for scan jobs only. The finishing
8065
method is specified by the application.
Note: Finishing features for scan jobs are not available at this time.
[L:FIN Jobs]
These SPs total finishing methods for jobs output from within the
8066
document server mode screen at the operation panel. The finishing
method is specified from the print window within document server mode.
[O:FIN Jobs]
These SPs total finishing methods for jobs executed by an external
8067
application, over the network. The finishing method is specified by the
application.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-06x-001 Sort C*
Number of jobs started in Sort mode.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-06x-002 Stack C* Number of jobs started out of Sort
mode.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-06x-003 Staple C*
Number of jobs started in Staple mode.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
Number of jobs started in Booklet
8-06x-004 Booklet C*
mode. If the machine is in staple mode,
the Staple counter also increments.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
Number of jobs started In any mode
8-06x-005 Z-Fold C*
other than the Booklet mode and set for
folding (Z-fold).
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
Number of jobs started in Punch mode.
8-06x-006 Punch C*
When Punch is set for a print job, the P:
counter increments. (See SP8-064-6.)
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-06x-007 Other C*
(Reserved)
[T:Jobs/PGS]
8071 These SPs count the number of jobs broken down by the number of
pages in the job, regardless of which application was used.
[C:Jobs/PGS]
8072 These SPs count and calculate the number of copy jobs by size based on
the number of pages in the job.
[F:Jobs/PGS]
8073 These SPs count and calculate the number of copy jobs by size based on
the number of pages in the job.
[P:Jobs/PGS]
8074 These SPs count and calculate the number of print jobs by size based on
the number of pages in the job.
[S:Jobs/PGS]
8075 These SPs count and calculate the number of scan jobs by size based on
the number of pages in the job.
[L:Jobs/PGS]
These SPs count and calculate the number of jobs printed from within the
8076
document server mode window at the operation panel, by the number of
pages in the job.
[O:Jobs/PGS]
These SPs count and calculate the number of "Other" application jobs
8077
(Web Image Monitor, Palm 2, etc.) by size based on the number of pages
in the job.
8-07x-001 1 Page C*
8-07x-002 2 Pages C*
8-07x-003 3 Pages C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-07x-004 4 Pages C*
8-07x-005 5 Pages C*
8-07x-006 6 to 10 Pages C*
8-07x-007 11 to 20 Pages C*
8-07x-008 21 to 50 Pages C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-07x-009 51 to 100 Pages C*
For example: When a copy job stored on the document server is printed in document server
mode, the appropriate L: counter (SP8-076-0xx) increments.
Printing a fax report counts as a job and increments the F: counter (SP8-073).
Interrupted jobs (paper jam, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.
If a job is paused and re-started, it counts as one job.
If the finisher runs out of staples during a print and staple job, then the job is counted at the
time the error occurs.
For copy jobs (SP8-072) and scan jobs (SP8-075), the total is calculated by multiplying the
SP Mode Tables
number of sets of copies by the number of pages scanned. (One duplex page counts as 2.)
Appendices:
The first test print and subsequent test prints to adjust settings are added to the number of
pages of the copy job (SP8-072).
When printing the first page of a job from within the document server screen, the page is
counted.
[T:S-to-Email Jobs]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white)
8131
scanned and attached to an e-mail, regardless of whether the document
server was used or not.
8-13x-001 B/W C*
8-13x-003 ACS C*
[T:Deliv Jobs/Svr]
8141 These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white)
scanned and sent to a Scan Router server.
8-14x-001 B/W C*
8-14x-003 ACS C*
SP Mode Tables
8-15x-003 ACS C*
Appendices:
Note: At the present time, SP8-151 and
SP8-155 perform identical counts.
8-17x-001 B/W C*
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-17x-002 Color C* These SPs count the pages scanned by
WS.
8-17x-003 ACS C*
8-18x-001 B/W C*
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-18x-002 Color C* These SPs count the scanned pages in
a media by the scanner application.
8-18x-003 ACS C*
These SPs count the number of scanned sides of pages, not the number of physical pages.
These counters do not count reading user stamp data, or reading color charts to adjust color.
Previews done with a scanner driver are not counted.
A count is done only after all images of a job have been scanned.
Scans made in SP mode are not counted.
Examples
If 3 B5 pages and 1 A3 page are scanned with the scanner application but not stored, the S:
count is 4.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server using the Store File
button in the Copy mode window, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied but not stored, the C: count is 6.
If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
These SPs count the total number of
large pages input with the scanner for
scan and copy jobs. Large size paper
8201 [T:LSize Scan PGS] C* (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission
is not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in
the SMC Report, and in the User Tools
display.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
These SPs count the total number of
large pages input with the scanner for
scan and copy jobs. Large size paper
8203 [F:LSize Scan PGS] C* (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission
is not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in
the SMC Report, and in the User Tools
display.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
These SPs count the total number of
large pages input with the scanner for
scan jobs only. Large size paper
8205 [S:LSize Scan PGS] C* (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission
is not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in
the SMC Report, and in the User Tools
display.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
Number of front sides fed for scanning:
With an ADF that can scan both sides
simultaneously, the Front side count is
the same as the number of pages fed for
either simplex or duplex scanning.
8-221-001 Front C*
With an ADF that cannot scan both sides
simultaneously, the Front side count is
the same as the number of pages fed for
duplex front side scanning. (The front
side is determined by which side the
user loads face-up.)
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
Number of rear sides fed for scanning:
With an ADF that can scan both sides
simultaneously, the Back count is the
same as the number of pages fed for
8-221-002 Back C*
duplex scanning.
With an ADF that cannot scan both sides
simultaneously, the Back count is the
same as the number of pages fed for
duplex rear-side scanning.
When 1 sheet is fed for duplex scanning the Front count is 1 and the Back count is 1.
If a jam occurs during the job, recovery processing is not counted to avoid double counting.
Also, the pages are not counted if the jam occurs before the first sheet is output.
[Scan PGS/Mode]
8231 These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each ADF mode to
determine the work load on the ADF.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-231-001 Large Volume C* Selectable. Large copy jobs that cannot
be loaded in the ADF at one time.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-231-002 SADF C* Selectable. Feeding pages one by one
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
through the ADF.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-231-003 Mixed Size C* Selectable. Select "Mixed Sizes" on the
operation panel.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-231-004 Custom Size C* Selectable. Originals of non-standard
size.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
Book mode. Raising the ADF and
8-231-005 Platen C*
placing the original directly on the
platen.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-231-006 Mixed 1side/ 2side C*
Simplex and Duplex mode.
If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to
Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode.
The user cannot select mixed sizes or non-standard sizes with the fax application so if the
original's page sizes are mixed or non-standard, these are not counted.
If the user selects "Mixed Sizes" for copying in the platen mode, the Mixed Size count is
enabled.
In the SADF mode if the user copies 1 page in platen mode and then copies 2 pages with
SADF, the Platen count is 1 and the SADF count is 3.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
These SPs count the total number of
8241 [T:Scan PGS/Org] C* scanned pages by original type for all
jobs, regardless of which application
was used.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8242 [C:Scan PGS/Org] C* These SPs count the number of pages
scanned by original type for Copy jobs.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8243 [C:Scan PGS/Org] C* These SPs count the number of pages
scanned by original type for copy jobs.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8245 [S:Scan PGS/Org] C* These SPs count the number of pages
scanned by original type for Scan jobs.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
These SPs count the number of pages
scanned and stored from within the
8246 [L:Scan PGS/Org] C* document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File
button from within the copy mode
screen
If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to
Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode.
SP Mode Tables
8252 [C:Scan PGS/ImgEdt] C*
Appendices:
Image Edit features have been selected
8255 [S:Scan PGS/ImgEdr] C* at the operation panel for each
application. Some examples of these
8256 [L:Scan PGS/ImgEdt] C*
editing features are:
Erase> Border
Erase> Center
Image Repeat
Centering
8257 [O:Scan PGS/ImgEdt] C* Positive/Negative
Note: The count totals the number of
times the edit features have been used.
A detailed breakdown of exactly which
features have been used is not given.
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen
at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen.
[T:Scan PGS/Size]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by all
8301
applications. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning)
and output (printing) page size [SP 8-441].
[C:Scan PGS/Size]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Copy
8302
application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and
output (printing) page size [SP 8-442].
[F:Scan PGS/Size]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Copy
8303
application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and
output (printing) page size [SP 8-442].
[S:Scan PGS/Size]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Scan
8305
application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and
output page size [SP 8-445].
[L:Scan PGS/Size]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned and stored
from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and
8306
with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen. Use these
totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP
8-446].
8-30x-001 A3 C*
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-30x-002 A4 C*
8-30x-003 A5 C*
8-30x-004 B4 C*
8-30x-005 B5 C*
8-30x-006 DLT C*
8-30x-007 LG C*
8-30x-008 LT C*
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
8-30x-009 HLT C*
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-30x-010 Full Bleed C*
When the A3/DLT double count function is switched on with SP5-104, 1 A3/DLT page is
counted as 2.
When several documents are merged for a print job, the number of pages stored is counted
for the application that stored them.
These counters are used primarily to calculate charges on use of the machine, so the
following pages are not counted as printed pages:
- Blank pages in a duplex printing job.
- Blank pages inserted as document covers, chapter title sheets, and slip sheets.
- Reports printed to confirm counts.
- All reports done in the service mode (service summaries, engine maintenance reports, etc.)
- Test prints for machine image adjustment.
- Error notification reports.
- Partially printed pages as the result of a copier jam.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
These SPs count pages printed on
paper sizes A3/DLT and larger.
8391 LSize PrtPGS C* Note: In addition to being displayed in
the SMC Report, these counters are
also displayed in the User Tools display
on the copy machine.
SP Mode Tables
8406 [L:PrtPGS/LS] C*
Appendices:
panel.
Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the L: count.
Fax jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the F: count.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
This SP counts the amount of paper
8411 Prints/Duplex C* (front/back counted as 1 page) used for
duplex printing. Last pages printed only
on one side are not counted.
[T:PrtPGS/Dup Comb]
8421 These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number
of pages processed for printing. This is the total for all applications.
[C:PrtPGS/Dup Comb]
8422 These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number
of pages processed for printing by the copier application.
[F:PrtPGS/Dup Comb]
8423 These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number
of pages processed for printing by the copier application.
[P:PrtPGS/Dup Comb]
8424 These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number
of pages processed for printing by the printer application.
[S:PrtPGS/Dup Comb]
8425 These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number
of pages processed for printing by the scanner application.
[L:PrtPGS/Dup Comb]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number
8426
of pages processed for printing from within the document server mode
window at the operation panel.
[O:PrtPGS/Dup Comb]
8427 These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number
of pages processed for printing by Other applications
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-42x-006 2in1 C*
2 pages on 1 side (2-Up)
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-42x-007 4 in1 C*
4 pages on 1 side (4-Up)
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-42x-008 6 in1 C*
6 pages on 1 side (6-Up)
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-42x-009 8 in1 C*
8 pages on 1 side (8-Up)
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-42x-010 9 in1 C*
9 pages on 1 side (9-Up)
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-42x-011 16 in1 C*
16 pages on 1 side (16-Up)
8-42x-012 Booklet C*
8-42x-013 Magazine C*
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
8-42x-023 9-in-1 + Magazine C*
These counts (SP8-421 to SP8-427) are especially useful for customers who need to improve
their compliance with ISO standards for the reduction of paper consumption.
Pages that are only partially printed with the n-Up functions are counted as 1 page.
Here is a summary of how the counters work for Booklet and Magazine modes:
Booklet Magazine
1 1 1 1
2 2 2 2
3 2 3 2
4 2 4 2
5 3 5 4
6 4 6 4
7 4 7 4
8 4 8 4
[T:PrtPGS/ImgEdt]
8431 These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
below, regardless of which application was used.
[C:PrtPGS/ImgEdt]
8432 These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
below with the copy application.
[P:PrtPGS/ImgEdt]
8434 These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
below with the print application.
[L:PrtPGS/ImgEdt]
These SPs count the total number of pages output from within the
8436
document server mode window at the operation panel with the three
features below.
[O:PrtPGS/ImgEdt]
8437 These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
below with Other applications.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
Total number of covers or slip sheets
8-43x-001 Cover/Slip Sheet C*
inserted. The count for a cover printed
on both sides counts 2.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
The number of pages printed in series
8-43x-002 Series/Book C*
(one side) or printed as a book with
booklet right/left pagination.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
The number of pages printed where
8-43x-003 User Stamp C*
stamps were applied, including page
numbering and date stamping.
[T:PrtPGS/Ppr Size]
8441 These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by all
applications.
[C:PrtPGS/Ppr Size]
8442 These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the
copy application.
[P:PrtPGS/Ppr Size]
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
8444 These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the
printer application.
[S:PrtPGS/Ppr Size]
8445 These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the
scanner application.
[L:PrtPGS/Ppr Size]
8446 These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed from
within the document server mode window at the operation panel.
[O:PrtPGS/Ppr Size]
8447 These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by Other
applications.
8-44x-001 A3 C*
8-44x-002 A4 C*
8-44x-003 A5 C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-44x-004 B4 C*
8-44x-005 B5 C*
8-44x-006 DLT C*
8-44x-007 LG C*
8-44x-008 LT C*
[PrtPGS/Ppr Tray]
8451
These SPs count the number of sheets fed from each paper feed station.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-451-001 Bypass Tray C*
Bypass Tray
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-451-006 Tray 5 C*
LCT (Option)
8-451-007 Tray 6 C*
8-451-008 Tray 7 C*
8-451-009 Tray 8 C*
8-451-010 Tray 9 C*
8-451-011 Tray 10 C*
Currently not used.
8-451-012 Tray 11 C*
8-451-013 Tray 12 C*
8-451-014 Tray 13 C*
8-451-015 Tray 14 C*
8-451-016 Tray 15 C*
[T:PrtPGS/Ppr Type]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by all
applications.
These counters are not the same as the PM counter. The PM counter
8461 is based on feed timing to accurately measure the service life of the
feed rollers. However, these counts are based on output timing.
Blank sheets (covers, chapter covers, slip sheets) are also counted.
During duplex printing, pages printed on both sides count as 1, and a
page printed on one side counts as 1.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[C:PrtPGS/Ppr Type]
8462 These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the copy
application.
[F:PrtPGS/Ppr Type]
8463 These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the copy
application.
[P:PrtPGS/Ppr Type]
8464 These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the printer
application.
[L:PrtPGS/Ppr Type]
8466 These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed from within the
document server mode window at the operation panel.
8-46x-001 Normal C*
8-46x-002 Recycled C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-46x-003 Special C*
8-46x-004 Thick C*
8-46x-008 Other C*
[PrtPGS/Mag]
8471
These SPs count by magnification rate the number of pages printed.
Counts are done for magnification adjusted for pages, not only on the operation panel but
performed remotely with an external network application capable of performing magnification
adjustment as well.
Magnification adjustments done with printer drivers with PC applications such as Excel are also
counted.
Magnification adjustments done for adjustments after they have been stored on the document
server are not counted.
Magnification adjustments performed automatically during Auto Reduce/Enlarge copying are
counted.
The magnification rates of blank cover sheets, slip sheets, etc. are automatically assigned a rate
of 100%.
8-51x-001 RPCS C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-51x-002 RPDL C*
8-51x-003 PS3 C*
8-51x-004 R98 C*
8-51x-005 R16 C*
8-51x-006 GL/GL2 C*
8-51x-008 RTIFF C*
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
8-51x-009 PDF C*
8-51x-010 PCL5e/5c C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-51x-011 PCL XL C*
8-51x-012 IPDL-C C*
8-51x-014 Other C*
8-51x-016 XPS C*
SP8-511 and SP8-514 return the same results as they are both limited to the Print application.
Print jobs output to the document server are not counted.
[T:PrtPGS/FIN]
8521 These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by
all applications.
[C:PrtPGS/FIN]
8522 These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by
the copy application.
[F:PrtPGS/FIN]
8523 These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by
the copy application.
[P:PrtPGS/FIN]
8524 These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by
the print application.
[S:PrtPGS/FIN]
8525 These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by
the scanner application.
[L:PrtPGS/FIN]
8526 These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed from
within the document server mode window at the operation panel.
8-52x-001 Sort C*
8-52x-002 Stack C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-52x-003 Staple C*
8-52x-004 Booklet C*
8-52x-005 Z-Fold C*
8-52x-007 Other C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-52x-008 Inside Fold C*
Half-Fold (FM2) (Multi Fold Unit)
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-52x-009 Three-IN-Fold C*
Letter Fold-in (FM4) (Multi Fold Unit)
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-52x-010 Three-OUT-Fold C*
Letter Fold-out (FM3) (Multi Fold Unit)
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-52x-011 Four Fold C* Double Parallel Fold (FM5) (Multi Fold
Unit)
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-52x-012 KANNON-Fold C*
Gate Fold (FM6) (Multi Fold Unit)
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-52x-013 Perfect-Bind C*
Perfect Binder
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-52x-014 Ring-Bind C*
Ring Binder
If stapling is selected for finishing and the stack is too large for stapling, the unstapled
pages are still counted.
The counts for staple finishing are based on output to the staple tray, so jam recoveries
are counted.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8531 [Staples] C* This SP counts the amount of staples
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
used by the machine.
[T:Counter]
These SPs count the total output broken down by color output, regardless
8581 of the application used. In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report,
these counters are also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy
machine.
8-581-001 Total C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-581-032 Total (A3) C*
[O:Counter]
These SPs count the totals for A3/DLT paper use, number of duplex pages
8591
printed, and the number of staples used. These totals are for Other (O:)
applications only.
8-591-001 A3/DLT C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-591-002 Duplex C*
[T:CoverageCounter]
8601 These SPs count the total coverage for each color and the total printout
pages for each printing mode.
8-617-001 SDK-1 C*
8-617-002 SDK-2 C*
8-617-003 SDK-3 C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-617-004 SDK-4 C*
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
8-617-005 SDK-5 C*
8-617-006 SDK-6 C*
8-621-001 Function-001 C*
8-621-002 Function-002 C*
8-621-003 Function-003 C*
8-621-004 Function-004 C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-621-005 Function-005 C*
8-621-006 Function-006 C*
8-621-007 Function-007 C*
8-621-008 Function-008 C*
8-621-009 Function-009 C*
8-621-010 Function-010 C*
8-621-011 Function-011 C*
8-621-012 Function-012 C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-621-013 Function-013 C*
8-621-014 Function-014 C*
8-621-015 Function-015 C*
8-621-016 Function-016 C*
8-621-017 Function-017 C*
8-621-018 Function-018 C*
8-621-019 Function-019 C*
8-621-020 Function-020 C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-621-021 Function-021 C*
8-621-022 Function-022 C*
8-621-023 Function-023 C*
8-621-024 Function-024 C*
8-621-025 Function-025 C*
8-621-026 Function-026 C*
8-621-027 Function-027 C*
8-621-028 Function-028 C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-621-029 Function-029 C*
8-621-030 Function-030 C*
8-621-031 Function-031 C*
8-621-032 Function-032 C*
8-621-033 Function-033 C*
8-621-034 Function-034 C*
8-621-035 Function-035 C*
8-621-036 Function-036 C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-621-037 Function-037 C*
8-621-038 Function-038 C*
8-621-039 Function-039 C*
8-621-040 Function-040 C*
8-621-041 Function-041 C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-621-042 Function-042 C*
8-621-043 Function-043 C*
8-621-044 Function-044 C*
8-621-045 Function-045 C*
8-621-046 Function-046 C*
8-621-047 Function-047 C*
8-621-048 Function-048 C*
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
8-621-049 Function-049 C*
8-621-050 Function-050 C*
8-621-051 Function-051 C*
8-621-052 Function-052 C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-621-053 Function-053 C*
8-621-054 Function-054 C*
8-621-055 Function-055 C*
8-621-056 Function-056 C*
8-621-057 Function-057 C*
8-621-058 Function-058 C*
8-621-059 Function-059 C*
8-621-060 Function-060 C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-621-061 Function-061 C*
8-621-062 Function-062 C*
8-621-063 Function-063 C*
8-621-064 Function-064 C*
8-65x-001 B/W C*
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-65x-002 Color C*
The count for B/W and Color pages is done after the document is stored on the HDD. If
the job is cancelled before it is stored, the pages are not counted.
If Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to 5 addresses, the count is 10 (the
pages are sent to the same SMTP server together).
If Scan-to-PC is used to send a 10-page document to 5 folders, the count is 50 (the
document is sent to each destination of the SMB/FTP server).
Due to restrictions on some devices, if Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page
document to a large number of destinations, the count may be divided and counted
separately. For example, if a 10-page document is sent to 200 addresses, the count is 10
for the first 100 destinations and the count is also 10 for the second 100 destinations, for
a total of 20.).
[T:Deliv PGS/Svr]
8661 These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan
Router server by both Scan and LS applications.
[S:Deliv PGS/Svr]
8665 These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan
Router server by the Scan application.
8-66x-001 B/W C*
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-66x-002 Color C*
The B/W and Color counts are done after the document is stored on the HDD of the Scan
Router server.
If the job is canceled before storage on the Scan Router server finishes, the counts are
not done.
The count is executed even if regardless of confirmation of the arrival at the Scan Router
server.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[T:Deliv PGS/PC]
8671 These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a folder
on a PC (Scan-to-PC) with the Scan and LS applications.
8-67x-001 B/W C*
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-67x-002 Color C*
8-68x-001 B/W C*
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-68x-002 Color C*
Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the count.
If several documents are merged for sending, the number of pages stored are counted
for the application that stored them.
When several documents are sent by a Fax broadcast, the F: count is done for the
number of pages sent to each destination.
[TX PGS/Port]
These SPs count the number of pages sent by the physical port used to
8701
send them. For example, if a 3-page original is sent to 4 destinations via
ISDN G4, the count for ISDN (G3, G4) is 12.
8-701-001 PSTN-1 C*
8-701-002 PSTN-2 C*
8-701-005 Network C*
8-71x-001 JPEG/JPEG2000 C*
8-71x-002 TIFF(Multi/Single) C*
8-71x-003 PDF C*
8-71x-006 PDF/A C*
8-71x-007 PDF(OCR) C*
8-71x-008 PDF/Comp(OCR) C*
SP Mode Tables
8731 [T:Scan PGS/Media]
Appendices:
8735 [S:Scan PGS/Media]
[RX PGS/Port]
8741 These SPs count the number of pages received by the physical port used
to receive them.
8-741-001 PSTN-1 C*
8-741-002 PSTN-2 C*
8-741-005 Network C*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
This SP counts the frequency of use
8771 [Dev Counter] C* (number of rotations of the
development rollers) for black and other
color toners.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1/step]
This SP displays the number of already
replaced toner bottles.
8781 [Toner_Botol_Info.] E* NOTE: Currently, the data in
SP7-833-011 through -014 and the data
in SP8-781-001 through -004 are the
same.
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1%/step]
This SP displays the percent of space
8791 [LS Memory Remain] C*
available on the document server for
storing documents.
[0 to 100 / 0 / 10%/step]
This SP displays the percent of toner
8801 [Toner Remain] C* remaining for each color. This SP
allows the user to check the toner
supply at any time.
8-811-005 Combine C*
8-811-105 Combine:Last C*
8-851-011 0 to 2%: BK E*
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
8-851-021 3 to 4%: BK E*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-851-031 5 to 7%: BK E*
8-851-041 8 to 10%: BK E*
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
This SP displays the number of
8861 [Cvr Cnt: 11-20%] E*
scanned sheets on which the coverage
of each color is from 11% to 20%.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
This SP displays the number of
8871 [Cvr Cnt: 21-30%] E*
scanned sheets on which the coverage
of each color is from 21% to 30%.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
This SP displays the number of
8881 [Cvr Cnt: 31%-] E*
scanned sheets on which the coverage
of each color is 31% or higher.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8891 [Page/Toner Bottle] E* This SP displays the amount of the
remaining current toner for each color.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8901 [Page/Toner_prev1] E* This SP displays the amount of the
remaining previous toner for each color.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
This SP displays the amount of the
8911 [Page/Toner_prev2] E*
remaining 2nd previous toner for each
color.
[Cvr Cnt/Total]
8921 This SP displays the total coverage and total printout number for each
color.
[Machine Status]
These SPs count the amount of time the machine spends in each
8941 operation mode. These SPs are useful for customers who need to
investigate machine operation for improvement in their compliance with
ISO Standards.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
Engine operation time. Does not
8-941-001 Operation Time C* include time while controller is saving
data to HDD (while engine is not
operating).
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
Engine not operating. Includes time
8-941-002 Standby Time C* while controller saves data to HDD.
Does not include time spent in Energy
Save, Low Power, or Off modes.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 10/step]
8-941-003 Energy Save Time C* Includes time while the machine is
performing background printing.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
Includes time in Energy Save mode
8-941-004 Low Power Time C* with Engine on. Includes time while
machine is performing background
printing.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
Includes time while machine is
8-941-005 Off Mode Time C* performing background printing. Does
SP Mode Tables
not include time machine remains
Appendices:
powered off with the power switches.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-941-006 SC C* Total time when SC errors have been
staying.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-941-007 PrtJam C* Total time when paper jams have been
staying during printing.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-941-008 OrgJam C* Total time when original jams have
been staying during scanning.
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-941-009 Supply PM Unit End C* Total time when toner end has been
staying
[AddBook Register]
8951 These SPs count the number of events when the machine manages data
registration.
[0 to 99999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-951-001 User Code/User ID C*
User code registrations.
[0 to 99999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-951-002 Mail Address C*
Mail addresses registrations.
[0 to 99999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-951-003 Fax Destination C*
Fax destination registrations.
[0 to 99999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-951-004 Group C*
Group destination registrations.
[0 to 99999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-951-005 Transfer Request C* Fax relay destination registrations for
relay TX.
[0 to 99999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-951-006 F-Code C*
F-Code box registrations
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
8-951-007 Copy Program C* Copy application registrations with the
Program (job settings) feature.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
8-951-008 Fax Program C* Fax application registrations with the
Program (job settings) feature.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
8-951-009 Printer Program C* Printer application registrations with the
Program (job settings) feature.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
8-951-010 Scanner Program C* Scanner application registrations with
the Program (job settings) feature.
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[0 to 99999999 / 0 / 1/step]
8-971-002 Power Off Count C*
8-999-001 Total C*
8-999-003 Copy: BW C*
8-999-013 Duplex C*
Scanner Transmission:
8-999-105 C*
BW
When entering the Input Check mode, 8 digits display the result for a section. Each digit
corresponds to a different device as shown in the table.
Bit No. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Result 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1
5-803-004 Bypass:Tray E
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
5-803-005 Paper Exit Full E
5-803-008 Registration E
5-803-010 Duplex:Entrance E
5-803-011 Duplex:Reverse E
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
5-803-028 Key Counter Set1 E
5-803-088 BANK2:Relay SN E
5-804-002 MainMT:CW:High E
5-804-004 MainMT:CW:Low E
5-804-005 MainMT:CCW:High E
5-804-006 MainMT:CCW:Mid E
5-804-007 MainMT:CCW:Low E
5-804-017 Duplex CL E
5-804-018 Bypass:Feed CL E
5-804-027 BICTL E
5-804-030 ExtRevMt:HOLD E
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
5-804-032 ExtRevMt:CW:Mid E
5-804-033 ExtRevMt:CW:Low E
5-804-034 ExtRevMt:CCW:Hi E
5-804-035 ExtRevMt:CCW:Mid E
5-804-163 BANK1:Motor:High E
5-804-164 BANK1:Motor:Mid E
5-804-165 BANK2:Motor:High E
5-804-166 BANK2:Motor:Mid E
5-804-170 BANK2:Feed CL E
SP Mode Tables
bit 0 DFU - -
Appendices:
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
If this bit switch is enabled, print jobs will be saved to the GW SD slot and
not output to paper.
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
Prints all RPCS and PCL jobs with a border around the printable area.
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 3 DFU - -
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
bit 0 DFU - -
SP Mode Tables
bit 1 DFU - -
Appendices:
bit 2 DFU - -
If enabled, the simplex pages of IPDS jobs will be printed on the front side
because of printing on the back side of the page. This might reduce
printing speed.
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
By default "Any Size/Type" and "Any Custom Size/Type" treat all paper in
the bypass tray as if it were loaded in the SEF direction. This bitswitch
changes the assumed direction to LEF.
bit 7 DFU - -
bit 0 If enabled, users will be able to configure a Collate Type, Staple Type, and
Punch Type from the operation panel. The available types will depend on
the device and configured options.
After enabling the function, the settings will appear under:
"User Tools > Printer Features > System"
If this switch is enabled, SDK applications will not be able to alter print
data. This is achieved by preventing SDK applications from accessing a
module called the "GPS Filter".
Note: The main purpose of this switch is for troubleshooting the effects of
SDK applications on data.
Changes the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the HDD.
The default (disabled) is 100. If this is enabled, the max. will be raised to
750.
bit 5 DFU - -
SP Mode Tables
specifications of older models for the binding of pages of mixed
Appendices:
orientation jobs.
The old models are below:
- PCL: Pre-04A models
- PS/PDF/RPCS:Pre-05S models
bit 7 Enabled
Letterhead mode printing Disabled
(Duplex)
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
bit 3 DFU - -
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
bit 3 Enabled
(allow BW
[PCL,PS]: Allow BW jobs to print without
Disabled jobs to print
requiring User Code
without a
user code)
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
SP Mode Tables
necessarily mean that the job can't be printed. This bit switch tells the device
Appendices:
whether to time-out immediately (default) upon failure or to wait 10 seconds.
bit 1 DFU - -
If this bit switch, all jobs will be cancelled after a jam occurs.
Note: If this bitsw is enabled, printing under the following conditions might
result in problems:
- Job submission via USB or Parallel Port
- Spool printing (WIM >Configuration > Device Settings > System)
bit 3 DFU - -
This switch determines the timing of the PJL USTATUS JOB END sent when
multiple collated copies are being printed.
0 (default): JOB END is sent by the device to the client after the first copy has
completed printing. This causes the page counter to be incremented after the
first copy and then again at the end of the job.
1: JOB END is sent by the device to the client after the last copy has finished
printing. This causes the page counter to be incremented at the end of each
job.
Enabled (=0):
Text composed of UTF-8 characters can be displayed in the operation panel.
Disabled (=1):
UTF-8 characters cannot be displayed in the operation panel.
For example, job names are sometimes stored in the MIB using UTF-8
encoded characters. When these are displayed on the operation panel, they
will be garbled unless this switch is enabled (=0).
Determines whether Print from USB/SD will have the Preview function.
Enabled (=0): Print from USB/SD will have the Preview function.
Disabled (=1): Print from USB/SD will not have the Preview function.
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
bit 3 DFU - -
bit 4 DFU - -
If this is 1, then after a job is stored using Auto Job Promotion, new jobs
cannot be added to the queue until the stored job has been completely
printed.
bit 7 DFU - -
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
1001 [Bit Switch]
bit 0 DFU - -
0 (default): Print jobs are not interrupted. If a job is promoted to the top of
the print queue, it will wait for the currently printing job to finish.
1: If a job is promoted to the top of the queue, it will interrupt the currently
printing job and start printing immediately.
bit 2 DFU - -
bit 3 DFU - -
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
bit 3 DFU - -
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
[- / - / -]
Initialize Printer System *CTL
001 [Execute]
[- / - / -]
003 Delete Program *CTL
[Execute]
[Print Summary]
1004
Prints the service summary sheet (a summary of all the controller settings).
[- / - / -]
001 Print Printer Summary CTL
[Execute]
- CTL [-/-/-]
001
Displays the version of the controller firmware.
[Sample/Locked Print]
1006
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
0:Link with Doc. Srv
001 CTL [- / 0 / -]
1:Enable
[Supply Display]
1-001-005 - C* -
[Erase margin]
Creates an erase margin for all edges of the scanned image.
1005
If the machine has scanned the edge of the original, create a margin. This
SP is activated only when the machine uses TWAIN scanning.
Range from 0 to 5
1-005-001 C* [0 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
mm
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
1-009-001 0:Enable 1:Disable C*
0: enable, 1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
1-010-001 0:Enable 1:Disable C*
0: Display, 1: No display
[UserInfo release]
1012 Clear the following settings:
Address, Sender, Text / Subject, Filename
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
1-012-001 0:NO 1:YES C*
0: No, 1: Yes
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
1-013-001 0:OFF 1:ON C*
0: OFF, 1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
1-014-001 0:OFF 1:ON C*
0: OFF, 1: ON
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
1-040-001 0:OFF 1:ON C*
0: OFF, 1: ON
Compression Ratio
2-024-001 [5 to 95 / 25 / 1 /step ]
(Normal)
C*
Compression Ratio
2-024-002 [5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]
(High)
Compression Ratio
2-025-001 [5 to 95 / 25 / 1 /step ]
(Normal) JPEG2000
C*
Compression Ratio
2-025-002 [5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]
(High) JPEG2000
SP Mode Tables
100
Appendices:
3.12.3 SP3-XXX
[-]
3043
-
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets the attachment method of the image data
read when mail transmission.
3-043-001 - C* 0: Attach a document that has been read (initial
value).
1: Attaches URL link of a document that has
been read.
[-]
3044
-
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1/step]
Sets compression method of image data that
3-044-001 - C* has been read when using clear light PDF.
0: high
1: normal (initial value)
[-]
3045
-
[0 to 5 / 5 / 1/step]
Selects priority search server when searching
mail address.
0: LDAP server 1
3-045-001 - C* 1: LDAP server 2
2: LDAP server 3
3: LDAP server 4
4: LDAP server 5
5: BODY address table (initial value)
[-]
3053
-
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets compression method of image data that
3-053-001 - C* has been read when using clear light PDF.
0: JPEG initial value
1: JPEG2000
Do not operate the machine until the test pattern is printed out completely. Otherwise, an
SP Mode Tables
Appendices:
SC occurs.
1. Enter the SP mode and select SP2-109-001.
2. Select the number for the test pattern that you want to print and press [OK].
3. Press the "Start" key to open the copy menu, then select the settings for the test print (paper
size etc.).
4. Press the "Start" key twice to start the test print.
5. After checking the test pattern, press [To SP] on the LCD to return to the SP mode.
6. Touch [Exit] three times to exit SP mode.
R E V I S I O N H I S T O RY
Pag e Date Ad d ed / Upd ated / New
None
M160/M161 FAX OPTION
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. INSTALLATION ................................................................................ 1
1.1 FAX UNIT OPTION ........................................................................................................... 1
1.1.1 HANDSET (HS1010) .............................................................................................. 1
Component Check ...................................................................................................... 1
Installation Procedure ................................................................................................. 1
Selecting the telephone line type of the handset ....................................................... 3
Adjusting the handset bell volume ............................................................................. 3
3. TROUBLESHOOTING...................................................................... 7
3.1 ERROR CODES ............................................................................................................... 7
3.2 IFAX TROUBLESHOOTING ........................................................................................... 29
3.3 IP-FAX TROUBLESHOOTING ....................................................................................... 32
3.3.1 IP-FAX TRANSMISSION...................................................................................... 32
Cannot send by IP Address/Host Name................................................................... 32
Cannot send via VoIP Gateway ............................................................................... 33
Cannot send by Alias Fax number ........................................................................... 34
3.3.2 IP-FAX RECEPTION ............................................................................................ 36
Cannot receive via IP Address/Host Name .............................................................. 36
Cannot receive by VoIP Gateway ............................................................................ 37
Cannot receive by Alias Fax number ....................................................................... 38
M160/M161 FAX
READ THIS FIRST
OPTION
Important Safety Notices
Before installing the fax unit, switch off the main switch, and disconnect the power cord.
The fax unit contains a lithium battery. The danger of explosion exists if a battery of this
type is incorrectly replaced. Replace only with the same or an equivalent type
recommended by the manufacturer. Discard batteries in accordance with the
manufacturer’s instructions and local regulations.
Screw
Connector
Clip ring
Clamp
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
The following headings provide special information:
Obey these guidelines to ensure safe operation and prevent minor injuries.
Obey these guidelines to avoid problems such as misfeeds, damage to originals, loss of
valuable data and to prevent damage to the machine.
Always obey these guidelines to avoid serious problems such as misfeeds, damage to
originals, loss of valuable data and to prevent damage to the machine. bold is added for
emphasis.
This document provides tips and advice about how to best service the machine.
Fax Unit Option
M160/M161 FAX
1. INSTALLATION
OPTION
1.1 FAX UNIT OPTION
Component Check
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
1 Handset 1
2 Cradle 1
3 Bracket 1
Installation Procedure
Do not apply strong impact or force to the handset bracket. Or it may be damaged.
The ferrite core is attached to the handset cord for reducing noise. Do not remove the
ferrite core.
1. Remove the protective tape from the handset bracket, and attach the bracket at the left
side of the machine, as shown below.
3. Fix the handset cradle to the handset bracket by turning the screws with a coin.
5. Place the handset on the handset cradle, and connect the handset cord to TEL.
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
Selecting the telephone line type of the handset
With a thin pointed object, set the switch on the handset to the line type you are using.
High : H
Low : L
No sound : OFF
2.1 FCU
The following data can be transferred: TTI, RTI, CSI, Fax bit switch settings, RAM
address settings, NCU parameter settings
1. Open the front cover.
2. Open the rear cover.
3. Remove the right cover [A] ( x 4, hook x 3).
4. Remove the five screws of the bracket [A] ( x 5), and then, remove the FCU board [B]
with bracket ( x 1, x 1)
M160/M161 FAX
5. Detach the bracket [B] and [C] from the FCU board [A]. ( x 3).
OPTION
6. Replace the FCU board. ( x2)
7. Slide the battery backup jumper switch [A] to the ON position.
8. Mount the new FCU board in the machine by means of the bracket. ( x5, x1)
9. Insert one end of the supplied flat cable into the CN603 connector on the new FCU
board.
Be careful not to insert the cable at an angle.
10. Insert the other end of the flat cable into the CN603 connector on the old FCU board.
Be careful not to insert the cable at an angle.
To prevent a short circuit, make sure the old FCU board does not come into contact
with anything metal.
11. Turn the main power switch on.
12. The SRAM data transfer begins. Transfer is complete when a beep sounds.
The volume of the beep is set to the same level as the speaker volume.
If the speaker volume is set to off, the volume of the beep is set to its initial
factory-set level.
If the machine does not beep, switch the main power off and then back on and try the
data transfer again. Try several times if necessary.
Be sure to check the transfer result after executing data transfer. If the transfer has
failed, you need to specify settings manually in the SP mode.
13. When the message "Ready" appears on the control panel, switch the power off, and
then remove the AC power plug from the receptacle.
14. Disconnect the flat cable from both FCU boards.
15. Reattach the covers.
16. Turn the main power switch on.
17. Enter the SP mode, print the system parameter list from SP6-101 in the Fax SP menu,
and then check the list to see whether the SRAM data has been transferred correctly.
M160/M161 FAX
3. TROUBLESHOOTING
OPTION
3.1 ERROR CODES
If an error code occurs, retry the communication. If the same problem occurs, try to fix the
problem as suggested below. Note that some error codes appear only in the error code display
and on the service report.
0-01 DCN received unexpectedly The other party is out of paper or has a
jammed printer.
The other party pressed Stop during
communication.
0-04 CFR or FTT not received after Check the line connection.
modem training Try changing the tx level and/or cable
equalizer settings.
Replace the FCU.
The other terminal may be faulty; try
sending to another machine.
If the rx signal is weak or defective, there
may be a bad line.
Cross reference
Tx level - NCU Parameter 01 (PSTN)
Cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN)
Dedicated tx parameters in Service
Program Mode
0-06 The other terminal did not Check the line connection.
reply to DCS Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable
equalizer settings.
Replace the FCU.
The other end may be defective or
incompatible; try sending to another
machine.
Check for line problems.
Cross reference
See error code 0-04.
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
0-08 The other end sent RTN or Check the line connection.
PIN after receiving a page, Replace the FCU.
because there were too many The other end may have jammed, or run
errors out of paper or memory space.
Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable
equalizer settings.
The other end may have a defective
modem/FCU; try sending to another
machine.
Check for line problems and noise.
Cross reference
Tx level - NCU Parameter 01 (PSTN)
Cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN)
Dedicated tx parameters in Service
Program Mode
0-15 The other terminal is not The other terminal is not capable of accepting
capable of specific functions. the following functions, or the other terminal’s
memory is full.
Confidential rx
Transfer function
SEP/SUB/PWD/SID
0-16 CFR or FTT not detected after Check the line connection.
modem training in confidential Replace the FCU.
or transfer mode Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable
equalizer settings.
The other end may have disconnected, or
it may be defective; try calling another
machine.
If the rx signal level is too low, there may
be a line problem.
Cross reference
See error code 0-08.
0-17 Communication was If the [Stop] key was not pressed and this error
interrupted by pressing the keeps occurring, replace the operation panel or
[Stop] key the operation panel drive board.
0-21 EOL signal (end-of-line) from Check the connections between the FCU
the other end not received and line.
within 5 s of the previous EOL Check for line noise or other line problems.
signal Replace the FCU.
The remote machine may be defective or
may have disconnected.
Cross reference
Maximum interval between EOLs and between
ECM frames - G3 Switch 0A, bit 4
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
0-22 The signal from the other end Check the line connection.
was interrupted for more than Replace the FCU.
the acceptable modem carrier Defective remote terminal.
drop time (default: 200 ms) Check for line noise or other line problems.
Try adjusting the acceptable modem
carrier drop time.
Cross reference
Acceptable modem carrier drop time - G3
Switch 0A, bits 0 and 1
0-29 Data block format failure in Check for line noise or other line problems.
ECM reception Check the FCU - NCU connectors.
Replace the NCU or FCU.
0-30 The other terminal did not Check the line connection.
reply to NSS(A) in AI short Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable
protocol mode. equalizer settings.
The other terminal may not be compatible.
Cross reference
Dedicated tx parameters - Section 4
0-32 The other terminal sent a Check the protocol dump list.
DCS, which contained Ask the other party to contact the
functions that the receiving manufacturer.
machine cannot handle.
0-33 The data reception (not ECM) Check the line connection.
is not completed within 10 The other terminal may have a defective
minutes. modem/FCU.
0-55 FCU does not detect the SG3. FCU firmware or board defective.
SG3 firmware or board defective.
0-70 The communication mode The other terminal did not have a
specified in CM/JM was not compatible communication mode (e.g., the
available. other terminal was a V.34 data modem and
(V.8 calling and called not a fax modem.)
terminal) A polling tx file was not ready at the other
terminal when polling rx was initiated from
the calling terminal.
0-74 The calling terminal fell back The calling terminal could not detect
to T.30 mode, because it ANSam due to noise, etc.
could not detect ANSam after ANSam was too short to detect.
sending CI. Check the line connection and condition.
Try making a call to another V.8/V.34 fax.
0-75 The called terminal fell back to The terminal could not detect ANSam.
T.30 mode, because it could Check the line connection and condition.
not detect a CM in response Try receiving a call from another V.8/V.34
to ANSam (ANSam timeout). fax.
0-76 The calling terminal fell back The called terminal could not detect a CM
to T.30 mode, because it due to noise, etc.
could not detect a JM in Check the line connection and condition.
response to CM Try making a call to another V.8/V.34 fax.
(CM timeout).
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
0-77 The called terminal fell back to The calling terminal could not detect a JM
T.30 mode, because it could due to noise, etc.
not detect a CJ in response to A network that has narrow bandwidth
JM cannot pass JM to the other end.
(JM timeout). Check the line connection and condition.
Try receiving a call from another V.8/V.34
fax.
0-79 The called terminal detected Check for line noise or other line problems.
CI while waiting for a V.21 If this error occurs, the called terminal falls
signal. back to T.30 mode.
0-80 The line was disconnected The guard timer expired while starting
due to a timeout in V.34 phase these phases. Serious noise, narrow
2 – line probing. bandwidth, or low signal level can cause
these errors.
0-81 The line was disconnected
If these errors happen at the transmitting
due to a timeout in V.34 phase
terminal:
3 – equalizer training.
Try making a call at a later time.
0-82 The line was disconnected Try using V.17 or a slower modem using
due to a timeout in the V.34 dedicated tx parameters.
phase 4 – control channel Try increasing the tx level.
start-up. Try adjusting the tx cable equalizer setting.
If these errors happen at the receiving terminal:
0-83 The line was disconnected
Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer setting.
due to a timeout in the V.34
Try increasing the tx level.
control channel restart
Try using V.17 or a slower modem if the
sequence.
same error is frequent when receiving from
multiple senders.
0-84 The line was disconnected The signal did not stop within 10 s.
due to abnormal signaling in Turn off the main power switch, then turn it
V.34 phase 4 – control back on.
channel start-up. If the same error is frequent, replace the
FCU.
0-85 The line was disconnected The signal did not stop within 10 s.
due to abnormal signaling in Turn off the main power switch, then turn it
V.34 control channel restart. back on.
If the same error is frequent, replace the
FCU.
0-86 The line was disconnected The other terminal was incompatible.
because the other terminal Ask the other party to contact the
requested a data rate using manufacturer.
MPh that was not available in
the currently selected symbol
rate.
0-87 The control channel started The receiving terminal restarted the control
after an unsuccessful primary channel because data reception in the
channel. primary channel was not successful.
This does not result in an error
communication.
0-88 The line was disconnected Try using a lower data rate at the start.
because PPR was Try adjusting the cable equalizer setting.
transmitted/received 9
(default) times within the
same ECM frame.
2-13 Modem initialization error Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.
Update the modem ROM.
Replace the FCU.
2-22 Counter overflow error of If error occurs frequently, change the settings
JBIG chip for resolution, paper size, compression type.
2-23 JBIG compression or Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.
reconstruction error
2-24 JBIG ASIC error Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
2-25 JBIG data reconstruction error JBIG data error
(BIH error) Check the sender’s JBIG function.
Update the FCU ROM.
2-26 JBIG data reconstruction error
(Float marker error)
2-50 The machine resets itself for a If this is frequent, update the ROM, or replace
fatal FCU system error the FCU.
2-51 The machine resets itself If this is frequent, update the ROM, or replace
because of a fatal the FCU.
communication error
2-53 Snd msg() in the manual task The user did the same operation many times,
is an error because the and this gave too much load to the machine.
mailbox for the operation task
is full.
4-10 Communication failed Get the ID Codes the same and/or the
because of an ID Code CSIs programmed correctly, then resend.
mismatch (Closed Network) or The machine at the other end may be
Tel. No./CSI mismatch defective.
(Protection against Wrong
Connections)
5-23 Print data error when printing Test the SAF memory.
a substitute rx or confidential Ask the other end to resend the message.
rx message
6-00 G3 ECM - T1 time out during Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer.
reception of facsimile data Replace the FCU.
6-08 G3 ECM - PIP/PIN received in The other end pressed Stop during
reply to PPS.NULL communication.
The other terminal may be defective.
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
6-09 G3 ECM - ERR received Check for a noisy line.
Adjust the tx levels of the communicating
machines.
See code 6-05.
6-21 V.21 flag detected during high The other terminal may be defective or
speed modem communication incompatible.
13-17 SIP user name registration Double registration of the SIP user name
error Capacity for user-name registration in the
SIP server is not sufficient.
13-18 SIP server access error Incorrect initial setting for the SIP server
Defective SIP server
13-25 Network I/F setting error IPV4 is not active in the active protocol
setting.
IP address of the device is not registered.
13-26 Network I/F setting error at Active protocol setting does not match the
power on I/F setting for SIP server.
IP address of the device is not registered.
14-00 SMTP Send Error Error occurred during sending to the SMTP
server. Occurs for any error other than 14-01 to
16. For example, the mail address of the
system administrator is not registered.
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
14-03 Access to SMTP Server Failed to access the SMTP server because
Denied (450) the access is denied.
SMTP server operating incorrectly.
Contact the system administrator to
determine if there is a problem with the
SMTP server and to check that the SMTP
server settings are correct.
Folder send destination is incorrect.
Contact the system administrator to
determine that the SMTP server settings
and path to the server are correct.
Device settings incorrect. Confirm that the
user name and password settings are
correct.
Direct SMTP destination incorrect. Contact
the system administrator to determine if
there is a problem at the destination at that
the settings at the destination are correct.
14-05 SMTP Server HDD Full (452) Failed to access the SMTP server because
the HDD on the server is full
Insufficient free space on the HDD of the
SMTP server. Contact the system
administrator and check the amount of
space remaining on the SMTP server
HDD.
Insufficient free space on the HDD where
the destination folder is located. Contact
the system administrator and check the
amount of space remaining on the HDD
where the target folder is located.
Insufficient free space on the HDD at the
target destination for SMTP direct sending.
Contact the system administrator and
check the amount of space remaining on
the target HDD.
14-06 User Not Found on SMTP The designated user does not exist.
Server (551) The designated user does not exist on the
SMTP server.
The designated address is not for use with
direct SMTP sending.
14-07 Data Send to SMTP Server Failed to access the SMTP server because
Failed (4XX) the transmission failed
PC not operating correctly
SMTP server operating incorrectly
Network not operating correctly
Destination folder setting incorrect
Direct SMTP sending not operating
correctly
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
14-08 Data Send to SMTP Server Failed to access the SMTP server because
Failed (5XX) the transmission failed
SMTP server operating incorrectly
Destination folder setting incorrect
Direct SMTP sending not operating
correctly.
Software application error
14-12 Data Size Too Large Transmission was cancelled because the
detected size of the file was too large.
14-14 Security Locked File Error Update the software because of the defective
software.
14-16 Maximum Division Number When a mail is divided for the mail
Error transmission and the division number of a
mail are more than the specified number,
the mail transmission is interrupted.
Update the software because of the
defective software.
14-18 Access to MCS File Error The access to MCS file is denied due to
the no permission of access.
Update the software because of the
defective software.
14-20 SMTP Authentication error Make sure the administrator's e-mail address is
same as the SMTP authentication address or
POP before SMTP address.
14-21 Transmission error of S/MIME Register the correct user certificate and device
certificate.
14-24 Destination and device Register the correct user certificate and device
certificate is in valid in certificate.
S/MIME.
14-30 MCS File Creation Failed Failed to create the MCS file because:
The number of files created with other
applications on the Document Server has
exceeded the limit.
HDD is full or not operating correctly.
Software error
14-31 UFS File Creation Failed UFS file could not be created:
Not enough space in UFS area to handle
both Scan-to-Email and IFAX transmission
HDD full or not operating correctly
Software error
14-32 Cancelled the Mail Due to Error detected with NFAX and send was
Error Detected by NFAX cancelled due to a software error.
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
14-33 No Mail Address For the Neither the mail address of the machine nor
Machine the mail address of the network administrator is
registered.
14-50 Mail Job Task Error Due to an FCU mail job task error, the send
was cancelled:
Address book was being edited during
creation of the notification mail.
Software error
14-51 UCS Destination Download Not even one return notification can be
Error downloaded:
The address book was being edited.
The number for the specified destination
does not exist (it was deleted or edited
after the job was created).
14-60 Send Cancel Failed The cancel operation by the user failed to
cancel the send operation.
14-61 Notification Mail Send Failed All addresses for return notification mail failed.
for All Destinations
14-62 Transmission Error due to the When the 0 line page exists in received pages
existence of zero line page with G3 communication, the transmission is
interrupted.
15-01 POP3/IMAP4 Server Not At startup, the system detected that the IP
Registered address of the POP3/IMAP4 server has not
been registered in the machine.
15-02 POP3/IMAP4 Mail Account The POP3/IMAP4 mail account has not been
Information Not Registered registered.
15-03 Mail Address Not Registered The mail address has not been registered.
15-10 DCS Mail Receive Error Error other than 15-11 to 15-18.
15-14 Mail Header Format Error The mail header is not standard format. For
example, the Date line description is incorrect.
15-15 Mail Divide Error The e-mail is not in standard format. There is
no boundary between parts of the e-mail,
including the header.
15-16 Mail Size Receive Error The mail cannot be received because it is too
large.
15-18 Incomplete Mail Received Only one portion of the mail was received.
15-31 Final Destination for Transfer The format of the final destination for the
Request Reception Format transfer request was incorrect.
Error
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
15-39 Send/Delivery Destination The transmission cannot be delivered to the
Error final destination:
Destination file format is incorrect.
Could not create the destination for the file
transmission.
15-42 Off Ramp Gateway Error The delivery destination address was specified
with Off Ramp Gateway OFF.
15-43 Address Format Error Format error in the address of the Off Ramp
Gateway.
15-44 Addresses Over The number of addresses for the Off Ramp
Gateway exceeded the limit of 30.
15-61 Attachment File Format Error The attached file is not TIFF format.
15-62 TIFF File Compatibility Error Could not receive transmission due to:
Resolution error
Image of resolution greater than 200 dpi
without extended memory.
Resolution is not supported.
Page size error
The page size was larger than A3.
Compression error
File was compressed with other than MH,
MR, or MMR.
15-63 TIFF Parameter Error The TIFF file sent as the attachment could not
be received because the TIFF header is
incorrect:
The TIFF file attachment is a type not
supported.
The TIFF file attachment is corrupted.
Software error
15-64 TIFF Decompression Error The file received as an attachment caused the
TIFF decompression error:
The TIFF format of the attachment is
corrupted.
Software error
15-71 Not Binary Image Data The file could not be received because the
attachment was not binary image data.
15-73 MDN Status Error Could not find the Disposition line in the header
of the Return Receipt, or there is a problem
with the firmware.
15-74 MDN Message ID Error Could not find the Original Message ID line in
the header of the Return Receipt, or there is a
problem with the firmware.
15-80 Mail Job Task Read Error Could not receive the transmission because
the destination buffer is full and the destination
could not be created (this error may occur
when receiving a transfer request or a request
for notification of reception).
15-91 Send Registration Error Could not receive the file for transfer to the final
destination:
The format of the final destination or the
transfer destination is incorrect.
Destinations are full so the final and
transfer destinations could not be created.
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
15-94 Incorrect ID Code The machine rejected an incoming e-mail for
transfer request, because the ID code in the
incoming e-mail did not match the ID code
registered in the machine.
15-95 Transfer Station Function The machine rejected an incoming e-mail for
transfer because the transfer function was
unavailable.
22-00 Original length exceeded the Divide the original into more than one
maximum scan length page.
Check the resolution used for scanning.
Lower the scan resolution if possible.
Add optional page memory.
22-01 Memory overflow while Wait for the files in the queue to be sent.
receiving Delete unnecessary files from memory.
Transfer the substitute reception files to an
another fax machine, if the machine’s
printer is busy or out of order.
Add an optional SAF memory card or hard
disk.
22-02 Tx or rx job stalled due to line The job started normally but did not finish
disconnection at the other end normally; data may or may not have been
received fully.
Restart the machine.
M160/M161 FAX
3.2 IFAX TROUBLESHOOTING
OPTION
Use the following procedures to determine whether the machine or another part of the network is
causing the problem.
Communication
Item Action [Remarks]
Route
General LAN 1. Connection with Check that the LAN cable is connected
the LAN to the machine.
Check that the LEDs on the hub are lit.
Between IFAX and 1. Network Check the network settings on the PC.
PC settings on the [Is the IP address registered in the TCP/IP
PC properties in the network setup correct?
Check the IP address with the
administrator of the network.]
Communication
Item Action [Remarks]
Route
Between e-mail 1. E-mail account Make sure that the PC can log into the
server and internet on the Server e-mail server.
Check that the account and password
stored in the server are the same as in
the machine.
[Ask the administrator to check.]
Communication
M160/M161 FAX
Item Action [Remarks]
Route
OPTION
1. Router settings Use the “ping” command to contact the
router.
Check that other devices connected to
the router can send data over the
router.
[Ask the administrator of the server to
check.]
6 Remote terminal port number setting other Send by specifying the port number.
than 1720 (when using H.323) or 5060
(when using SIP)?
7 Specified port number correct? Confirm the port number of the remote
fax.
8 DNS server registered when host name Contact the network administrator.
specified?
9 Remote fax a T.38 terminal? Check whether the remote fax is a T38
terminal.
10 Remote fax switched off or busy? Check that the remote fax is switched
on.
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
IP-Fax bandwidth is the same as the
DCS speed. Set IP-Fax SW00 Bit 6 to
1.
6 Number of the specified fax correct? Check the remote fax number.
2 Number of specified Alias fax correct? Confirm the Alias of the remote fax.
Error Code: 13-14
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
11 Alias number of local fax registered? Register the Alias number of the local
fax.
13 Remote fax a T.38 terminal? Check whether the remote fax is a T38
terminal.
4 Port number specified at remote sender Request the sender to specify the port
fax (if required)? number.
5 Specified port number correct (if Request the sender to check the port
required)? number.
6 DNS server registered when host name Contact the network administrator.
specified on sender side?
The sender machine displays
this error code if the sender
fax is a Ricoh model.
M160/M161 FAX
Cannot receive by VoIP Gateway
OPTION
Check Point Action
5 IP address/host name of specified VoIP Request the remote fax to check the IP
Gateway correct on sender’s side? address/host name.
6 DNS server registered when host name Contact the network administrator.
specified on sender side?
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
7 Enable H.323/Enable SIP SW is set to on? Request the sender to check the
settings.
User Parameter SW 34 Bit 0/SW 34
Bit 1
4. SERVICE TABLES
4.1 CAUTIONS
Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid
damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation power switch to switch the power
off, wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off.
The main power LED lights or flashes while the platen cover or ARDF is open, while the
main machine is communicating with a facsimile or the network server, or while the
machine is accessing the hard disk or memory for reading or writing data.
M160/M161 FAX
4.2 SERVICE PROGRAM TABLES
OPTION
4.2.1 SP1-XXX (BIT SW)
System Switch
101 Change the bit switches for system settings for the
001 – 032 00 – 1F fax option
"page 48 "Bit Switches - 1"" : "System Switches"
I fax Switch
102 001 – 016 00 – 0F Change the bit switches for internet fax settings for
the fax option
"page 64 "Bit Switches - 2"" : "I-Fax Switches"
Printer Switch
103 001 – 016 00 – 0F Change the bit switches for printer settings for the fax
option
"page 64 "Bit Switches - 2"" : "Printer Switches"
Communication Switch
G3-1 Switch
105 001 – 016 00 – 0F Change the bit switches for the protocol settings of
the standard G3 board
"page 88 "Bit Switches - 4"" : "G3 Switches"
IP fax Switch
111 001 – 016 00 – 0F Change the bit switches for optional IP fax
parameters
"page 99 "Bit Switches - 6"" : "IP Fax Switches"
Memory Dump
102 001 G3-1 Memory Print out RAM data for the fax board.
Dump page 134 "Service RAM Addresses"
103 001 – 023 CC, 01 – 22 NCU parameter settings for the standard G3
board. page 111 "NCU Parameters"
M160/M161 FAX
4.2.3 SP3-XXX (MACHINE SET)
OPTION
3 Mode No. Function
Service Station
101
001 Fax Number Enter the fax number of the service station.
102 000 Serial Number Enter the fax unit’s serial number.
001 Select Line Select the line type setting for the G3-1 line. If
the machine is installed on a PABX line, select
“PABX”, “PABX(GND)” or “PABX(FLASH)”.
103 002 PSTN Access Enter the PSTN access number for the G3-1
Number line.
FAX SW
201
001 – 032 00 – 1F
101 001 FCU ROM Version Displays the FCU ROM version.
102 001 Error Codes Displays the latest 64 fax error codes.
103 001 G3-1 ROM Version Displays the G3-1 modem version.
101 000 Initialize SRAM (except Initializes the bit switches and user
Secure) parameters, user data in the SRAM, files in
the SAF memory, and clock.
102 000 Erase All Files Erases all files stored in the SAF memory.
103 000 Reset Bit Switches Resets the bit switches and user parameters.
(except Secure)
104 000 Factory Setting Resets the bit switches and user parameters,
user data in the SRAM and files in the SAF
memory.
105 000 Reset All Bit Switches Resets all the current bit switch settings.
106 000 Reset Security Bit Resets only the security bit switches. If you
Switches select automatic output/display for the user
parameter switches, the security settings are
initialized.
M160/M161 FAX
4.2.6 SP6-XXX (REPORTS)
OPTION
6 Mode No. Function
101 000 System Parameter List Touch the “ON” button to print the system
parameter list.
102 000 Service Monitor Report Touch the “ON” button to print the service
monitor report.
105 000 All Files print out Prints out all the user files in the SAF memory,
including confidential messages.
001 All log files These log print out functions are for designer
use only.
002 Printer
004 Decompression
005 Scanner
006 JOB/SAF
007 Reconstruction
008 JBIG
010 G3CCU
012 CCU
M160/M161 FAX
4.2.7 SP7-XXX (TESTS)
OPTION
These are the test modes for PTT approval.
7 Function
Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.
Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
Example:
(1): EQM value (Line quality data). A larger number means more errors.
(2): Symbol rate (V.34 only)
(3): Final modem type used
(4): Starting data rate (for example, 288 means 28.8 kbps)
(5): Final data rate
(6): Rx revel (see below for how to read the rx level)
(7): Total number of error lines that occurred during non-ECM reception.
(8): Total number of burst error lines that occurred during non-ECM reception.
Rx level calculation
Example:
The four-digit hexadecimal value (N) after "L" indicates the rx level.
The high byte is given first, followed by the low byte. Divide the decimal value of
N by -16 to get the rx level.
In the above example, the decimal value of N (= 0100 [H]) is 256.
So, the actual rx level is 256/-16 = -16 dB
No Function Comments
G3 Communication Parameters
0: 0 ms/line
M160/M161 FAX
5: 5 ms/line
OPTION
10: 10 ms/line
20: 20 ms/line
I/O rate 25: 2.5 ms/line
40: 40 ms/line
System Switch 01 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
System Switch 05 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 06 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 07 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 08 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
Printing of the error code on the 1: Error codes are printed on the error reports.
3 error report This can be used for detecting an error which
0: No 1: Yes occurs rarely.
No Function Comments
On hook dial
5 0: On hook dial is disabled.
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
System Switch 0B - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 0C - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
11: USA
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
TTI: 08 to 92 (BCD) mm
Input even numbers only.
This setting determines the print start position
for the TTI from the left edge of the paper. If the
TTI printing position in the main
0-7 TTI is moved too far to the right, it may
scan direction
overwrite the file number which is on the top
right of the page. On an A4 page, if the TTI is
moved over by more than 50 mm, it may
overwrite the page number.
System Switch 14 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
1 0 1 hour
1 1 24 hours
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
System Switch 17 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
OPTION
System Switch 18 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
System Switch 1F (SP No. 1-101-032)
OPTION
No Function Comments
Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.
Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.
No Function Comments
3-6 Reserved
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
0 200x100 Standard
1 200x200 Detail
4 400 x 400 Super Fine the higher resolution has priority. For example,
if both Bit 0 and Bit 2 are set to "1" Then The
5 600 x 600 Reserve Resolution is set for "Bit 2 200 x 400.
6 Reserve
7 mm/inch
No Function Comments
This setting determines whether the header information is printed with text
e-mails when they are received.
0: Prints only text mail.
0 1: Prints mail header information attached to text mail.
When a text mail is received with this switch On (1), the "From" address and
"Subject" address are printed as header information.
When a mail with only binary data is received (a TIFF-F file, for example), this
setting is ignored and no header is printed.
This setting determines whether only the first page or all pages of an e-mail
attachment are printed at the sending station when a transmission error occurs.
1 This allows the customer to see which documents have not reached their
intended destinations if sent to the wrong e-mail addresses, for example.
0: Prints 1st page only.
1: Prints all pages.
2-3 This setting determines the text string output for the Return Receipt that confirms
the transmission was received normally at the destination.
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
00: "Dispatched"
Sends from PC mail a request for a Return Receipt. Receives the Return Receipt
with "dispatched" in the 2nd part:
Disposition: Automatic-action/MDN-send automatically; dispatched
The "dispatched" string is included in the Subject string.
01: "Displayed"
Sends from PC mail a request for a Return Receipt. Receives the Return Receipt
with "displayed" in the 2nd part:
Disposition: Automatic-action/MDN-send automatically; displayed
The "displayed" string is included in the Subject string.
10: Reserved
11: Reserved
A mail requesting a Return Receipt sent from an IFAX with this switch set to "00"
(for "dispatched") received by Microsoft Outlook 2000 may cause an error. If any
setting other than "displayed" (01) causes a problem, change the setting to "01"
to enable normal sending of the Return Receipt.
This setting adds or does not add the media accept feature to the answer mail to
confirm a reception.
4 0: Does not add the media accept feature to the answer mail
1: Adds the media accept feature to the answer mail.
Use this bit switch if a problem occurs when the machine receives an answer
mail, which contains the media accept feature field.
7 0: 200 x 200
1: 400 x 400
The "1" setting requires installation of the Memory Unit in order to have enough
SAF (Store and Forward) memory to receive images at 400 x 400 resolution.
I-fax Switch 03 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
This setting determines whether the RTI/CSI registered on this machine or the
RTI/CSI of the originator is used in the subject lines of transferred documents.
0: Puts the RTI/CSI of the originator in the Subject line. If this is used, either the
0 RTI or CSI is used. Only one of these can be received for use in the subject line.
1: Puts the RTI/CSI registered on this machine in the Subject line.
When this switch is used to transfer and deliver mail to a PC, the information in
the Subject line that indicates where the transmission originated can be used to
determine automatically the destination folder for each e-mail.
This switch does not apply for condition 3) when the RX system is set up
for memory sending, delivery by F-code, sending with SMTP RX and
when operators are using FOL (to prevent problems when receiving
transmissions).
M160/M161 FAX
I-fax Switch 05 (SP No. 1-102-006)
OPTION
No Function Comments
0 For example:
"1st destination + Total number of destinations: 9" in the Journal indicates a
broadcast to 9 destinations.
0: Not recorded
1: Recorded
IFAXTX Retries
Determines whether the machine retries sending IFAX when connection and
1 transmission fails due to errors.
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
I-fax Switch 07 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
This setting determines the amount of SAF (Store and Forward) memory. (SAF
stores fax messages to send later for transmission to more than one location, and
also holds incoming messages if they cannot be printed.) When the amount of
0-7 SAF memory available falls below this setting, mail can no longer be received;
received mail is then stored on the mail server.
00-FF (0 to 1024 KB: HEX)
The hexadecimal number you enter is multiplied by 4 KB to determine the amount
of memory.
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
0 1 No setting
1 0 Individual setting
1 1 Always sign
0 0 No sign
4-5 In response to IEEE2600.1.
0 1 No setting
1 0 Individual setting
1 1 Always sign
I-fax Switch 0E - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
This setting determines whether files received with SMTP protocol are delivered
0 or output immediately.
0: Off. Files received via SMTP are output immediately without delivery.
1: On. Files received via SMTP are delivered immediately to their destinations.
1 0: No sign
1: Always sign
2 0: No encryption
1: Encryption
No Function Comments
Printer Switch 01 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
Relationship between available paper sizes and printer width used in the setup protocol
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
A4 or 8.5" x 11" 297 mm width
B5 256 mm width
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
Maximum reducible length when length reduction is enabled with switch 03-0
above.
[Maximum reducible length] = [Paper length] + (N x 5mm)
"N" is the decimal value of the binary setting of bits 0 to 4.
0 0 0 0 1 5 mm
0 0 1 0 0 20 mm
1 1 1 1 1 155 mm
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
Length of the duplicated image on the next page, when page separation has
taken place.
0 1 10 mm
1 0 15 mm
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
Printer Switch 08 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
OPTION
Printer Switch 0E (SP No. 1-103-015)
No Function Comments
Paper size selected for printing This switch determines which paper size is
A4 width fax data selected for printing A4 width fax data, when
1*
0: 8.5" x 11" size the machine has both A4 and 8.5" x 11" size
1: A4 size paper.
1 0 Same size
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
Smoothing feature
1 0 Enabled
Duplex printing
1: The machine always prints received
2* 0: Disabled
fax messages in duplex printing mode:
1: Enabled
M160/M161 FAX
4.5 BIT SWITCHES - 3
OPTION
Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.
Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.
No Function Comments
1 0 MH/MR/MMR
1 1 MH/MR/MMR/JBIG
1 1 MH/MR/MMR/JBIG
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
Wrong connection prevention (0,1): The machine will disconnect the line
method without sending a fax message, if the last 8
digits of the received CSI do not match the last
Bit 3 Bit 2 Setting
8 digits of the dialed telephone number. This
0 0 None does not work when manually dialed.
(1,0): The same as above, except that only the
0 1 8 digit CSI
last 4 digits are compared.
1 0 4 digit CSI (1,1): The machine will disconnect the line
2-3
without sending a fax message, if the other end
1 1 CSI/RTI
does not identify itself with an RTI or CSI.
(0,0): Nothing is checked; transmission will
always go ahead.
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
1 0 A4 (297 mm)
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
Remote mode switch number Enter the number to switch between TEL/FAX
0-3
00-09 (0-9:HEX) modes using the external phone.
Communication Switch 06 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
Communication Switch 07 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
Communication Switch 0C - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
06 to FF (Hex), unit = 2 s
(e.g., 06(H) = 12 s)
Minimum interval between
0-7 This value is the minimum time that the
automatic dialing attempts
machine waits before it dials the next
destination.
Communication Switch 0F – Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
Memory transmission:
Maximum number of dialing
0-7 01 – FE (Hex) times
attempts to the same
destination.
M160/M161 FAX
Communication Switch 11 – Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
OPTION
Communication Switch 12 (SP No. 1-104-019)
No Function Comments
Communication Switch 13 – Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
1 0 mm and inch
Communication Switch 15 – Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
Communication Switch 16 – Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
No Function Comments
PWD reception
0: Disables features that require PWD
2 0: Disabled
(Password) signal reception.
1: Enabled
M160/M161 FAX
Communication Switch 18 (SP No. 1-104-025)
OPTION
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.
Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.
4.6.1 G3 SWITCHES
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
G3 Switch 01 (SP No. 1-105-002)
OPTION
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
0 - F (Hex); 0 - 15 bits
Training error detection If the number of error bits in the received TCF
0-3
threshold is below this threshold, the machine informs
the sender that training has succeeded.
No Function Comments
Initial Tx modem rate (kbps) These bits set the initial starting modem
rate for transmission.
Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 kbps
Use the dedicated transmission
0 0 0 1 2.4 parameters if you need to change this for
specific receivers.
0-3 0 0 1 0 4.8
If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is
0 0 1 1 7.2 selected, V.8 protocol should be disabled
manually.
0 1 0 0 9.6
Cross reference
0 1 0 1 12.0 V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit 2
No Function Comments
0 1 1 0 14.4
0 1 1 1 16.8
1 0 0 0 19.2
1 0 0 1 21.6
1 0 1 0 24.0
1 0 1 1 26.4
1 1 0 0 28.8
1 1 0 1 31.2
1 1 1 0 33.6
Bit 5 Bit 4 Setting These bits set the initial modem type for
4-5 9.6 and 7.2 kbps, if the initial modem rate
0 0 V.29
is set at these speeds.
0 1 V.17
1 0 V.34
M160/M161 FAX
G3 Switch 06 (SP No. 1-105-007)
OPTION
No Function Comments
0 0 0 1 2.4
0 0 1 0 4.8
0 0 1 1 7.2
1 0 1 0 24.0
1 0 1 1 26.4
1 1 0 0 28.8
1 1 0 1 31.2
1 1 1 0 33.6
0 0 0 1 V.27ter
0 0 1 0 V.27ter, V.29
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
1 0 800
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
3000-2250ms: 3000-50xNms
0-7 High order bit 3000 – 50 x Nms 0F (3000 ms) <= N <= FF (2250
ms)
00-0E(3000-3700ms: 3000+50xNms
Low order bit 3000 – 50 x Nms 0F (3000 ms) <= N <= 0F (3700
ms)
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
4.7 BIT SWITCHES - 6
OPTION
Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as "Not used", as this may
cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local
regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.
Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List
printed by the machine.
No Function Comments
IP Fax Transport
1 Selects TCP or UDP protocol for IP-Fax
0: TCP, 1: UDP
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
0 0 0 1 Level 1
0 0 1 0 Level 2
0 0 1 1 Level 3
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
IP Fax Switch 04 (SP No. 1-111-005)
OPTION
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
0 0 0 1 2.4
Sets the modem bit rate for
0-3 0 0 1 0 4.8 transmission. The default is "0110"
0 1 0 0 9.6
0 1 0 1 12.0
0 1 1 0 14.4
0 1 V17
No Function Comments
4-7 0 0 0 1 V.27ter
0 0 1 0 V.27ter, V.29
M160/M161 FAX
IP Fax Switch 07 (SP No. 1-111-008)
OPTION
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
T1 timer adjustment
Bit 1 Bit 0
1 0 50 s
1 1 60 s
T4 timer adjustment
Bit 3 Bit 2
1 0 4s
1 1 5s
T0 timer adjustment
Adjusts the fail safe timer. This timer sets
Bit 5 Bit 4
the interval between "setup" data
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No Function Comments
Bit 4 Bit 3
This changes the interval for transmit
3-4 0 0 No delay re-INVITE after receiving the ACK message
1 0 2 sec
1 1 3 sec
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
IP Fax Switch 0B (SP No. 1-111-012)
OPTION
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
No Function Comments
M160/M161 FAX
4.8 NCU PARAMETERS
OPTION
The following tables give the RAM addresses and the parameter calculation units that the
machine uses for ringing signal detection and automatic dialing. The factory settings for each
country are also given. Most of these must be changed by RAM read/write (SP2-102), but some
can be changed using NCU Parameter programming (SP2-103); if SP2-103 can be used, this will
be indicated in the Remarks column. The RAM is programmed in hex code unless (BCD) is
included in the Unit column.
Address Function
Use the Hex value to program the country/area code directly into this
address, or use the decimal value to program it using SP2-103-001
Country Country
Decimal Hex Decimal Hex
/Area /Area
France 00 00 Asia 18 12
Germany 01 01 Japan 19 13
UK 02 02 Hong Kong 20 14
New
Belgium 05 05 26 17
Zealand
Denmark 06 06 Singapore 24 18
Finland 07 07 Malaysia 25 19
Ireland 08 08 China 26 1A
Norway 09 09 Taiwan 27 1B
Sweden 10 0A Korea 28 1C
Switzerland 11 0B Brazil 29 1D
Address Function
Portugal 12 0C Turkey 32 20
Holland 13 0D Greece 33 21
Spain 14 0E Hungary 34 22
Israel 15 0F Czech 35 23
USA 17 11 Poland 36 24
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
68050E PSTN wait interval (HIGH)
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
PABX busy tone frequency
680528 If both addresses contain
lower limit (high byte)
Hz (BCD) FF (H), tone detection is
PABX busy tone frequency disabled.
680529
lower limit (low byte)
Busy tone signal state time tolerance for all ranges, and number of cycles
required for detection (a setting of 4 cycles means that ON-OFF-ON or
OFF-ON-OFF must be detected twice).
Tolerance (±)
680533 Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 75% Bits 2 and 3 must always be kept at 0.
Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 50% Bits 2 and 3 must always be kept at 0.
Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 25%
Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 12.5%
Bits 7, 6, 5, 4 - number of cycles required for cadence detection
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
Country dial tone continuous
680546 - -
tone time
See Note 3.
68054B Break time for pulse dialing 1 ms SP2-103-013 (parameter
12).
See Note 3.
68054C Make time for pulse dialing 1 ms SP2-103-014 (parameter
13).
SP2-103-018 (parameter
680550 DTMF tone on time
17).
1 ms
SP2-103-019 (parameter
680551 DTMF tone off time
18).
SP2-103-020 (parameter
Tone attenuation level of DTMF -N x 0.5
680552 19).
signals while dialing –3.5 dBm
See Note 5.
SP2-103-021 (parameter
20).
Tone attenuation value
The setting must be less
difference between high
680553 -dBm x 0.5 than –5dBm, and should not
frequency tone and low
exceed the setting at
frequency tone in DTMF signals
680552h above.
See Note 5.
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
This time is waited for each
pause input after the PSTN
access code. If this address
contains FF[H], the pause
68055D PSTN access pause time 20 ms
time stored in address
68054F is used.
Do not set a number more
than 7 in the UK.
68055F
to Not used - Do not change the settings.
680564
680567
to Not used - Do not change the settings.
680571
SP2-103-007 (parameter
Number of rings until a call is 06).
680576 1
detected. The setting must not be
zero.
See Note 4.
Minimum required length of the
680577 20 ms SP2-103-008 (parameter
first ring
07).
68057B
to Not used - Do not change the settings.
680580
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
680583
to Not used - Do not change the settings.
6805A0
20 ms ± 20
6805A5 CED detection time Factory setting: 200 ms
ms
SP2-103-002 (parameter
6805B4 PSTN: Tx level from the modem -N – 3 dBm
01).
6805BE to
Not used - Do not change the settings.
6805C6
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
Bits 0 to 3 – Not used
6805C7 Bit 4 = V.34 protocol dump 0: Simple, 1: Detailed (default)
Bits 5 to 7 – Not used.
6805C8 to
Not used - Do not change the settings.
6805D9
NOTES
1. If a setting is not required, store FF in the address.
2. Italy and Belgium only
RAM address 68055E: the lower four bits have the following meaning.
Bit 2 - 1: International dial tone cadence detection enabled (Belgium)
Bit 1 - Not used
Bit 0 - 1: PSTN dial tone cadence detection enabled (Italy)
If bit 0 or bit 2 is set to 1, the functions of the following RAM addresses are changed.
680508 (if bit 0 = 1) or 680538 (if bit 2 = 1): tolerance for on or off state duration (%), and
M160/M161 FAX
68050B (if bit 0 = 1) or 68053B (if bit 2 = 1): on time, hex code (unit = 20 ms)
OPTION
68050C (if bit 0 = 1) or 68053C (if bit 2 = 1): off time, hex code (unit = 20 ms)
3. Pulse dial parameters (addresses 68054A to 68054F) are the values for 10 pps. If 20 pps is
used, the machine automatically compensates.
4. The first ring may not be detected until 1 to 2.5 wavelengths after the time specified by this
parameter.
5. The calculated level must be between 0 and 10.
The attenuation levels calculated from RAM data are:
High frequency tone:
– 0.5 x N680552/680554–3.5 dBm
– 0.5 x N680555 dBm
Low frequency tone:
– 0.5 x (N680552/680554 + N680553) –3.5 dBm
– 0.5 x (N680555 + N680553) dBm
4.9.2 PARAMETERS
Fax Parameters
The initial settings of the following fax parameters are all FF(H) - all the parameters are disabled.
Switch 00
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
FUNCTION AND COMMENTS
Switch 01
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
Tx level
1 1 1 1 1 Disabled
Switch 01
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
Switch 02
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
Switch 02
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
0 1 1 1 16800
1 0 0 0 19200
1 0 0 1 21600
1 0 1 0 24000
1 0 1 1 26400
1 1 0 0 28800
1 1 0 1 31200
1 1 1 0 33600
1 1 1 1 Disabled
Switch 03
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
Switch 03
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
2-3 DIS/NSF detection method (0, 1): Use this setting if echoes on
Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 0 = First DIS or NSF the line are interfering with the set-up
Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 1 = Second DIS or NSF protocol at the start of transmission.
Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 0 = Not used The machine will then wait for the
Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 1 = Disabled second DIS or NSF before sending
DCS or NSS.
If the setting is "Disabled", the bit
switch setting is used.
M160/M161 FAX
Switch 06 - Not used (Do not change the settings.)
OPTION
Switch 07 - Not used (Do not change the settings.)
E-mail Parameters
The initial settings of the following e-mail parameters are all "0" (all parameters disabled).
Switch 00
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
Switch 01
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
0 Original width of e-mail attachment: A4 Sets the original width of the e-mail
0: Off attachment as A4.
1: On
Switch 02
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
0 Line resolution of e-mail attachment: 200 x Sets the line resolution of the e-mail
100 attachment as 200 x100.
0: Off
1: On
1 Line resolution of e-mail attachment: 200 x Sets the line resolution of the e-mail
200 attachment as 200 x 200.
0: Off
1: On
Switch 04
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
Switch 05
No FUNCTION COMMENTS
0 Direct transmission selection to SMTP Allows or does not allow the direct
server transmission to SMTP server.
0: ON
1: OFF
Do not change the settings which are marked as “Not used” or “Read only.”
680001 to 680004(H) - ROM version (Read only)
680001(H) - Revision number (BCD)
680002(H) - Year (BCD)
680003(H) - Month (BCD)
680004(H) - Day (BCD)
680006 to 680015(H) - Machine’s serial number (16 digits - ASCII)
680016(H) - Language code
0: Japanese, 1: UK English, 2: US English, 3: French, 4: German, 5: Spanish, 6: Italian, 7: Dutch,
8: Swedish, 9: Norwegian, 10: Danish, 11: Finnish, 12: Czech, 13: Hungarian, 14: Polish, 15:
Portuguese, 16: Russian, 17: Traditional Chinese, 18: Simplified Chinese, 19: Korean
680018(H) - Total program checksum (low)
680019(H) - Total program checksum (high)
680020 to 68003F(H) - System bit switches
680050 to 68005F(H) - Printer bit switches
680060 to 68007F(H) - Communication bit switches
680080 to 68008F(H) - G3 bit switches
6800D2(H) - User parameter switch 02 (SWUSR_02)
Bit 0: Forwarding mark printing on forwarded messages 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 1: Center mark printing on received copies (This switch is not printed on the user parameter
list.) 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 2: Reception time printing (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Disabled,
1: Enabled
Bit 3: TSI print on received messages 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 4: Checkered mark printing (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Disabled,
1: Enabled
Bit 5 and 6: Not used
6800D3(H) - User parameter switch 03 (SWUSR_03: Automatic report printout)
Bit 0: Transmission result report (memory transmissions) 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 1: Not used
Bit 2: Memory storage report 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 3: Polling reserve report (polling reception) 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 4: Polling result report (polling reception) 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 5: Transmission result report (immediate transmissions) 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 6: Not used
Bit 7: Journal 0: Off, 1: On
SM 134 M160/M161 Fax Option
Service RAM Addresses
M160/M161 FAX
Bit 0: Not used
OPTION
Bit 1: Automatic communication failure report and transfer result report output 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 4: Indicates the parties 0: Not indicated, 1: Indicated
Bit 5: Include sender’s name on reports 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 7: Inclusion of a sample image on reports 0: Off, 1: On
6800D5(H) - User parameter switch 05 (SWUSR_05)
Bit 0: Substitute reception when the base copier is in an SC condition 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled
Bits 1 and 2: Condition for substitute rx when the machine cannot print messages (Paper end,
toner end, jam, and during night mode)
Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 0 = The machine receives all the fax messages.
Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 1 = The machine receives the fax messages with RTI or CSI.
Bit 2: 1, Bit 1: 0 = The machine receives the fax messages with the same ID code.
Bit 2: 1, Bit 1: 1 = The machine does not receive anything.
Bit 4: Not used
Bit 5: Just size printing 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 6: Not used
Bit 7: Add paper display when a cassette is empty 0: Off, 1: On
6800D6(H) - User parameter switch 06 (SWUSR_06): Not used
6800D7(H) - User parameter switch 07 (SWUSR_07)
Bit 0 Ringing 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 1: Automatic answering message 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 2: Parallel memory transmission 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 5: Remote control 0: Off, 1: On
6800D8(H) - User parameter switch 08 (SWUSR_08)
Bits 1: Not used.
Bit 2: Authorized reception 0: Only faxes from senders whose RTIs/CSIs are specified for this
feature are accepted., 1: Only faxes from senders whose RTIs/CSIs are not specified for this
feature are accepted.
6800DA(H) - User parameter switch 10 (SWUSR_0A)
Bits 0: Restrict control panel operations such as printing or deleting received documents 0: Off,
1: On
Bits 1: Combined two originals 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 3 to 5: Not used
Bit 6: Use both e-mail notification and printed reports to confirm the transmission results 0: Off,
1: On
Bit 7: Have the machine delete the document data without printing it when an error occurs 0: Off,
1: On
6800DB(H) - User parameter switch 11 (SWUSR_0B)
M160/M161 FAX
Bit 3: TTI page number 0: Off, 1: On
OPTION
Bit 7: Japan only
6800E3(H) - User parameter switch 19 (SWUSR_13)
Bit 0: Use paper delivery shift function 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 1: Sort Journal by line type 0: The Journal is separated into transmissions and receptions., 1:
The Journal is separated into G3-1, G3-2, and G3-3 communications
Bit 2: Select the function to postpone the printing of a received file if the selected paper tray has
run out of paper 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 3: Not used
Bit 4: Reduction of sample images on reports to 50% in the main scan and sub-scan directions.
(This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Technician adjustment (printer switch
0E bits 3 and 4), 1: 50% reduction
Bit 5: Use of A5 size paper for reports (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0:
Off, 1: On
6800E4(H) - User parameter switch 20 (SWUSR_14)
Bit 0: Automatic printing of the LAN fax result report 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 1: Not used
Bits 2 to 5: Store documents in memory which could not be printed from PC fax (LAN fax) driver
0 0 0 0 0 min.
0 0 0 1 1 min.
1 1 1 0 14 min.
1 1 1 1 15 min.
Bit 5: Limit printing of subjects and texts in normal e-mail (attached TIFF files) 0: No, 1: Yes
Bit 6: Network error display 0: Displayed, 1: Not displayed
Bit 7: Transmit error mail notification 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled
6800E6(H) - User parameter switch 22 (SWUSR_16)
(This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.)
Bit 0: Dial tone detection (PSTN 1) 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bits 1 to 7: Not used
6800E7(H) – User parameter switch 23 (SWUSR_17)
Bit 0 to 7: Information to be printed for transmit terminal identification (TTI)
6800E8(H) - User parameter switch 24 (SWUSR_18)
Bit 0: Store documents that could not be transmitted in memory 0: Off, 1: On
Bit 1: Length of time documents that could not be transmitted are stored in memory 0: 24hours,
1: 72 hours
Bit 2: Retain the files stored in the Document Server, regardless of the settings of [Auto Delete File
in Document Server] under [System Settings] 0: No, 1: Yes
Bit 3: Cancel the use of the fixed sentence when sending a file by e-mail 0: No, 1: Yes
6800E9(H) - User parameter switch 25 (SWUSR_19)
Bit 1: Reception mode switch timer 0: Off, 1: On (switching Fax or Fax/Tel)
Bit 2: Mode priority switch 0: Fax first, 1: Tel first
Bit 3: Dial in function (Japan Only)
Bit 4: Not used.
Bit 5 to 7: Not used
6800EA(H) and 6800EB(H) - User parameter switches 26 and 27 (SWUSR_1A and 1B): Not
used
6800EC(H) - User parameter switch 28(SWUSR_1C): Not used
6800ED(H) - User parameter switch 29(SWUSR_1D): Not used
6800EE(H) and 6800EF(H) - User parameter switches 30 and 31 (SWUSR_1E and 1F): Not
used
6800F0(H) - User parameter switch 32 (SWUSR_20)
Bit 0: Quotation priority for a destination when there is no destination of the specified type 0:
Paper output priority = Priority order: 1. IP-fax destination, 2. Fax Number, 3. E-mail address, 4.
Folder
1: Electric putout order = Priority order: 1. E-mail address, 2. Folder, 3. IP-fax destination, 4. Fax
number
Bits 1 to 7: Not used
6800F1(H) - User parameter switch 33 (SWUSR_21): Not used
6800F2(H) - User parameter switch 34 (SWUSR_22)
Bit 0: Gatekeeper server used with IP-Fax 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 1: SIP server used with IP-Fax 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
M160/M161 FAX
6800F3(H) - User parameter switch 35 (SWUSR_23)
OPTION
Redial interval when sending a backup file
6800F4(H) - User parameter switch 36 (SWUSR_24)
Maximum number of redials when sending a backup file
6800F5(H) - User parameter switch 37 (SWUSR_25)
Bit 0: Whether to stop sending a backup file if the destination folder becomes full while the
machine is sending or waiting to send a fax or the backup file. 0: No, 1: Yes
Bit 2 and 3: Backup file is printed along with the TX communication failure report when a backup
file transmission failure occurs. 00: Do not print, 01: Print first page only, 10: Print whole file
Bit 4: Display the sender's information in the file name of documents that are forwarded to folder
destinations. 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 5: Limit the file names of documents that are forwarded to folder destinations to plain
characters only. 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 6: When using the remote fax function, the sub-machine beeps to let you know when it has
printed a received document (If you specify "On", the machine will beep according to the setting of
[Panel Key Sound] under [System Settings].) 0: On, 1: Off
6800F6(H) - User parameter switch 38 (SWUSR_26): Not used
6800F7(H) - User parameter switch 39 (SWUSR_27): Not used
6800F8(H) - User parameter switch 40 (SWUSR_28)
Bit 0: When memory space is insufficient, the machine prints and then deletes the oldest faxes,
creating memory space for storage of new faxes. 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
6800FD (H) - User parameter switch 45 (SWUSR_2D)
Bit 0 and 1: Not used
Bit 2: File format for files transmitted to e-mail addresses and folders registered as forwarding,
destinations of backup file transmission, receivers for Personal Box, or end receivers for Transfer
Box. 0: PDF 1: PDF/A
Bit 3: Specify the criteria for printing files when forwarding them 0: Depends on Reception file
settings, 1: Do not print
680130 to 68016F(H) - Service Switches
680170 to 68017F(H) - IFAX Switches
680180 to 68018F(H) - IP-FAX Switches
680190 to 6801A3(H) - PSTN-1 RTI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII) - See the following note.
6801CF to 68020E(H) - TTI 1 (Max. 64 characters - ASCII) - See the following note.
68020F to 68024E(H) - TTI 2
68024F to 68028E(H) - TTI 3
68028F to 6802CE(H) - TTI 4
6802CF to 68030E(H) - TTI 5
68030F to 68034E(H) - TTI 6
If the number of characters is less than the maximum (20 for RTI, 32 for TTI), add a stop
code (00[H]) after the last character.
68044F(H) - Printing format for TTI 1 0: DOM (Japan), 1:EXP (Export)
680450(H) - Printing format for TTI 2 0: DOM, 1:EXP
680451(H) - Printing format for TTI 3 0: DOM, 1:EXP
680452(H) - Printing format for TTI 4 0: DOM, 1:EXP
680453(H) - Printing format for TTI 5 0: DOM, 1: EXP
680454(H) - Printing format for TTI 6 0: DOM, 1: EXP
680455(H) - Printing format for TTI 7 0: DOM, 1: EXP
680456(H) - Printing format for TTI 8 0: DOM, 1: EXP
680457(H) - Printing format for TTI 9 0: DOM, 1: EXP
680458(H) - Printing format for TTI 10 0: DOM, 1: EXP
680459 to 68046C(H) - PSTN-1 CSI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII)
680495(H) - Number of PSTN-1 CSI characters (Hex)
6804C6(H) - Memory Lock ID (BCD)
6804D2 to 6804D9(H) - Last power off time (Read only)
6804D2(H) - 01(H) - 24-hour clock, 00(H) - 12-hour clock (AM), 02(H) - 12-hour clock (PM)
6804D3(H) - Year (BCD)
6804D4(H) - Month (BCD)
6804D5(H) - Day (BCD)
6804D6 (H) - Hour
6804D7 (H) - Minute
6804D8(H) - Second
6804D8 (H) - 00: Monday, 01: Tuesday, 02: Wednesday, /// , 06: Sunday
6804E6(H) - Optional equipment (Read only – Do not change the settings)
Bit 0: Page Memory 0: Not installed, 1: Installed
Bit 1: SAF Memory (4M) 0: Not installed, 1: Installed
Bit 2: SAF Memory 0: Not installed, 1: Installed
Bits 3 to 7; Not used
6804E7(H) - Optional equipment (Read only – Do not change the settings)
Bits 0 to 7: Not used
6804EE(H) - Machine code (Check ram 3)
680500(H) - Start address of G3 table for G3-1
680820 to 68083F(H) - Service station’s fax number (SP3-101)
M160/M161 FAX
68084A to 680853(H) - Own fax number (PSTN) - Not used
OPTION
680868 to 680873(H) - The first subscriber number (ISDN G3) - Not used
680874 to 68087F(H) - The second subscriber number (ISDN G3) - Not used
680908(H) - G3-1 Modem ROM version (Read only)
680918(H) - Number of multiple sets print (Read only)
68096E(H) - Not used
68096F(H) - Not used
68098A(H) - Transmission monitor volume 00 - 07(H)
68098B(H) - Reception monitor volume 00 - 07(H)
68098C(H) - On-hook monitor volume 00 - 07(H)
68098D(H) - Dialing monitor volume 00 - 07(H)
68098E(H) - Buzzer volume 00 - 07(H)
68098F(H) - Beeper volume 00 - 07(H)
6809A0(H) - Machine code (Check ram 4)
6809CA(H) - Machine serial number (ASCII)
686D98 to 686D9B(H) - Transmission counter 00000000 - FFFFFFFF(H)
686D9C to 686D9F(H) - Reception counter 00000000 - FFFFFFFF(H)
686E08 to 686E0B(H) - Mail transmission counter 00000000 - FFFFFFFF(H)
686E0C to 686E0F(H) - Mail reception counter 00000000 - FFFFFFFF(H)
6A69EE(H) to 6A6CED(H) - SIP server address (Read only)
6A69EE(H) - Proxy server - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A6A6E(H) - Proxy server - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A6AEE(H) - Redirect server - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A6B6E(H) - Redirect server - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A6BEE(H) - Registrar server - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A6C6E(H) - Registrar server - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A6CEE(H) - Gatekeeper server address - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A6D6E(H) - Gatekeeper server address - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A6DEE(H) - Alias Number (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A6E6E(H) - SIP user name (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A6EEE(H) - SIP digest authentication password (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A6F6E(H) - Gateway address information (Max. 7100 characters - ASCII)
6A8B2A(H) - NGN initial setting method 0: Simple, 1: Manual
6A8B2B(H) - SIP digest authentication user name (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A8BAB(H) - NGN-SIP domain name (Max. 64 characters - ASCII)
6A8BEB(H) - NGN-home gateway address (Max. 128 characters - ASCII)
6A8C6C(H) - Stand-by port number for H.323 connection
6A8C6E(H) - Stand-by port number for SIP connection
NA F4 01
EU F4 01
ASIA F4 01
M160/M161 FAX
5. DETAILED SECTION DESCRIPTIONS
OPTION
5.1 OVERVIEW
The FCU controls all the fax communications and fax features, in cooperation with the controller
board. Also, the FCU contains the ROM, SRAM and NCU circuits.
5.2 BOARDS
5.2.1 FCU
The FCU (Facsimile Control Unit) controls fax communications, the video interface to the base
copier’s engine, and all the fax options.
Modem (FAME2)
V.34, V33, V17, V.29, V.27ter, V.21, and V.8
DRAM
The 16 MB of DRAM is shared as follows.
SAF memory: 4MB
Working memory: 4MB
Page memory: 4MB
The SAF memory is backed up by a rechargeable battery.
M160/M161 FAX
SAF Memory Back-up
OPTION
A rechargeable battery backs up the SAF memory (DRAM) for 12 hours.
ROM
4 MB flash ROMs for system software storage
SRAM
The 512 KB SRAM for system and user parameter storage is backed up by a lithium battery.
SRAM Back-up
A lithium battery backs up the system parameters and programmed items in the SRAM, in case
the base copier's main power switch is turned off.
Switches
Item Description
CPU
This controls the energy-efficient operation of the FCU board.
Mail Transmission
This machine supports T.37 full mode. (ITU-T Recommendation, RFC2532). The difference
between T.37 simple mode and full mode is as follows.
200 x100
200 x 100 200 x 200
Resolution
200 x 200 200 x 400
400 x 400 (if available)
M160/M161 FAX
Data Formats
OPTION
The scanned data is converted into a TIFF-F formatted file.
The fields of the e-mail and their contents are as follows:
Field Content
Multipart/mixed
Content Type
Attached files: image/tiff
In this case, this feature destination e-mail address ([email protected]) is read as the SMTP server
address "gts.abcd.com", and the transmissions bypass the SMTP server.
Selectable Options
These options are available for selection:
With the default settings, the scan resolution can be either standard or detail. Inch-mm
conversion before TX depends on IFAX SW01 Bit 7. Detail resolution will be used if Super
Fine resolution is selected, unless Fine resolution is enabled with IFAX SW01.
The requirements for originals (document size, scan width, and memory capacity) are the
same as for G3 fax memory TX.
The default compression is TIFF-F format.
IFAX SW00: Acceptable paper widths for sending
IFAX SW09: Maximum number of attempts to the same destination
Mail Reception
This machine supports three types of e-mail reception:
POP3 (Post Office Protocol Ver. 3.)
IMAP4 (Internet Messaging Access Protocol)
SMTP (Simple Mail Transfer Protocol)
M160/M161 FAX
SMTP Reception
OPTION
1. The IFAX must be registered as an SMTP server in the MX record of the DNS server, and the
address of the received mail must specify the IFAX.
2. To enable SMTP reception: User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> Reception Protocol
Even if the MX record on the DNS server includes the IFAX, mail cannot be received with
SMTP until SMTP reception is enabled:
However, if SMTP reception is selected and the machine is not registered in the MX
record of the DNS server, then either IMAP4 or POP3 is used, depending on the setting:
User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> Reception Protocol
Auth. E-mail RX
In order to limit access to mail delivery with IFAX, the addresses of senders must be limited using
the Access Limit Entry. Only one entry can be registered.
1. Access Limit Entry
For example, to limit access to @IFAX.ricoh.co.jp:
2. Conditions
The length of the Access Limit Entry is limited to 127 characters.
If the Access Limit Entry address and the mail address of the incoming mail do not match,
the incoming mail is discarded and not delivered, and the SMTP server responds with an
error. However, in this case an error report is not output.
If the Access Limit Entry address is not registered, and if the incoming mail specifies a
delivery destination, then the mail is delivered unconditionally.
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
Content-Transfer-
Base 64, 7-bit, 8-bit, Quoted Printable
Encoding
Field Content
Multipart/mixed
Content-Type
Text/Plain (for a text part), image/tiff (for attached files)
Field Content
Subject
--- Entry Condition
Entry
M160/M161 FAX
OPTION
RTI or CSI of
the station
Mail delivery
designated for
Mail error
--- Error Message No. xxxx From CSI (RTI)
notification
E-mail Messages
After entering the subject, you can enter a message with: Sub TX Mode> E-mail Options
An e-mail message (up to 5 lines) can be pre-registered with: User Tools> System Settings> File
Transfer> Program/Change/Delete E-mail Message
Limitations on Entries
Item Maximum
M160/M161 FAX
Normal reception: “Return Receipt (dispatched)” in the Subject line
OPTION
IFAX SW02 (Bit 2, 3) “Return Receipt (displayed)” in the Subject line
Handling Reports
1. Sending a Request for a Return Receipt by Mail
After the mail sender transmits a request for a return receipt, the mail sender's journal is
annotated with two hyphens (--) in the Result column and a "Q" in the Mode column.
2. Mail Receipt (Request for Receipt Confirmation) and Sending Mail Receipt Response
After the mail receiver sends a response to the request for a return receipt, the mail receiver's
journal is annotated with two hyphens (--) in the Result column and an "A" in the Mode
column.
3. Receiving the Return Receipt Mail
After the mail sender receives a return receipt, the information in the mail sender's journal
about the receipt request is replaced, i.e. the journal is annotated with "OK" in the Result
column.
When the return receipt reports an error, the journal is annotated with an "E" in the Result
column.
The arrival of the return receipt is not recorded in the journal as a separate
communication. Its arrival is only reported by the presence of "OK" or "E" in the Result
column.
If the mail address used by the sender specifies a mailing list (i.e., a Group destination;
the machine sends the mail to more than one location. See "How to set up Mail Delivery"),
the Result column of the Journal is updated every time a return receipt is received. For
example, if the mailing list was to 5 destinations, the Result column indicates the result of
the communication with the 5th destination only. The results of the communications to the
first 4 destinations are not shown.
Exceptions: If one of the communications had an error, the Result column will indicate E,
even if subsequent communications were OK.
If two of the communications had an error, the Journal will indicate the destination for the first
error only.
Report Sample
M160/M161 FAX
5.4 IP-FAX
OPTION
5.4.1 WHAT IS IP-FAX?
For details: Core Technology Manual – Facsimile Processes – Faxing from a PC – Internet/LAN
Fax Boards – IP-FAX
IP-Fax Switch 01
5.4.3 SETTINGS
User parameter switch 34 (22[H]), bit 0
IP-Fax Gate Keeper usage, 0: No, 1: Yes
IP Fax Switches: Various IP-FAX settings (see the bit switch table)
6. SPECIFICATIONS
6.1.1 FCU
Standard: Group 3
Transmissi
3 seconds at 28,800 bps, Standard resolution (JBIG transmission: 2 seconds)
on Time:
Data
Compressi MH, MR, MMR, JBIG
on:
Maximum
Standard: A4 (SEF) or 8.5” x 14” (SEF)
Original
Custom: 216 mm x 600 mm (8.5” x 23.6”)
Size:
Maximum
Scanning 216 mm x 600 mm (8.5” x 23.6”)
Size:
Print
LED alley and electro-photographic printing
Process:
Transmissi 33,600/31,200/28,800/26,400/24,000/21,600/19,200/16,800/14,400/12,000/9,600/
on speed: 7,200/4,800/2,400 bps (Auto shift down system)
M160/M161 FAX
6.2 CAPABILITIES OF PROGRAMMABLE ITEMS
OPTION
The following table shows the capabilities of each programmable items.
Item Standard
Groups 100
Programs 100
Measured using an ITU-T #1 test document (Slerexe letter) at the standard resolution,
the auto image density mode and the Text mode.
Original Size
A4, (8.5” x 14”)
(Scanning width):
Authentication
SMTP-AUTH, POP before SMTP, A-POP
method:
Internet Send and receive e-mail with a computer that has an e-mail
communication: address
Encryption
S/MIME
method:
Internet Fax send Automatic conversion of sent documents to e-mail format and
functions: e-mail transmission. Memory transmission only.
Internet Fax Automatic detection and printing of appended TIFF-F (MH) files
receive functions: and ASCII text. Memory receptiononly.
M160/M161 FAX
*1 :Full mode
OPTION
The machine must be set up as an e-mail client before installation. Any client PCs
connected to the machine through a LAN must also be e-mail clients, or some features
will not work (e.g. Autorouting).
Maximum scanning
216 mm x 600 mm (8.5” x 23.6”)
size:
Compatible
IP-Fax compatible machines
machines:
M160/M161 FAX
6.5 FAX UNIT CONFIGURATION
OPTION
Component No. Remarks
FCU 1
Speaker 2
SM i M440/M441
Overview
(M440/M441)
1.1 OVERVIEW
1.1.1 SPECIFICATION
SM 1 M440/M441
Overview
M440/M441 2 SM
Overview
(M440/M441)
The paper size is detected by a combination of three detection switches on a Paper Size
Detection Switch [2]. The switches are operated by the Size Detection Dial [1] located on the right
side of the Paper Feed Tray.
SM 3 M440/M441
Overview
SW 1 SW 2 SW 3 Paper Size
1 L L L A4 SEF
2 L H L A5 SEF
3 H L L A6 LEF
4 H H L Legal SEF
5 L L H Letter SEF
6 L H H -
M440/M441 4 SM
Overview
(M440/M441)
the bottom plate by springs.
1. Tray arms
2. Springs
3. Bottom plate
1. Optional bank
2. Feeler
3. Paper end sensor
SM 5 M440/M441
Paper Feed Unit PB1060 (250 sheets) / PB1070 (500 sheets)
(500 SHEETS)
2.1.2 EXTERIOR
Be sure to release two tabs on the bottom of (and behind) the right cover while trying to
remove it.
M440/M441 6 SM
Paper Feed Unit PB1060 (250 sheets) / PB1070 (500 sheets)
Be sure to release two tabs on the bottom of (and behind) the right cover while trying to
remove it.
SM 7 M440/M441
Paper Feed Unit PB1060 (250 sheets) / PB1070 (500 sheets)
M440/M441 8 SM
Paper Feed Unit PB1060 (250 sheets) / PB1070 (500 sheets)
(M440/M441)
2. Right Cover (page 6 "Exterior")
3. Tray Main Board [A] ( x4, x all)
SM 9 M440/M441
Paper Feed Unit PB1060 (250 sheets) / PB1070 (500 sheets)
3. Detach the paper feed motor [B] from the bracket [A]. ( x2)
M440/M441 10 SM
Paper Feed Unit PB1060 (250 sheets) / PB1070 (500 sheets)
(M440/M441)
2. Bracket [A] ( x4)
SM 11 M440/M441
Paper Feed Unit PB1060 (250 sheets) / PB1070 (500 sheets)
M440/M441 12 SM
Paper Feed Unit PB1060 (250 sheets) / PB1070 (500 sheets)
(M440/M441)
2. Right Cover (page 6 "Exterior")
3. Bracket [A] with Paper Size Switch ( x2, x1, x1)
4. Detach the paper size switch from the bracket [A]. (Hook x2)
SM 13 M440/M441